You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.
 
 
 
 
 
 

11269 lines
422 KiB

  1. \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
  2. @c %**start of header
  3. @setfilename openocd.info
  4. @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
  5. @dircategory Development
  6. @direntry
  7. * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
  8. @end direntry
  9. @paragraphindent 0
  10. @c %**end of header
  11. @include version.texi
  12. @copying
  13. This User's Guide documents
  14. release @value{VERSION},
  15. dated @value{UPDATED},
  16. of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
  17. @itemize @bullet
  18. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
  19. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
  20. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
  21. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
  22. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
  23. @end itemize
  24. @quotation
  25. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
  26. under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
  27. any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
  28. Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
  29. Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
  30. Free Documentation License''.
  31. @end quotation
  32. @end copying
  33. @titlepage
  34. @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
  35. @sp 1
  36. @title OpenOCD User's Guide
  37. @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
  38. @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
  39. @page
  40. @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
  41. @insertcopying
  42. @end titlepage
  43. @summarycontents
  44. @contents
  45. @ifnottex
  46. @node Top
  47. @top OpenOCD User's Guide
  48. @insertcopying
  49. @end ifnottex
  50. @menu
  51. * About:: About OpenOCD
  52. * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
  53. * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
  54. * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
  55. * Running:: Running OpenOCD
  56. * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
  57. * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
  58. * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
  59. * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
  60. * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
  61. * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
  62. * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
  63. * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
  64. * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
  65. * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
  66. * General Commands:: General Commands
  67. * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
  68. * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
  69. * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
  70. * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
  71. * TFTP:: TFTP
  72. * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
  73. * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
  74. * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
  75. * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
  76. * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
  77. @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
  78. @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
  79. @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
  80. @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
  81. * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
  82. * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
  83. @end menu
  84. @node About
  85. @unnumbered About
  86. @cindex about
  87. OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
  88. at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
  89. Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
  90. supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
  91. around the world.
  92. @section What is OpenOCD?
  93. @cindex TAP
  94. @cindex JTAG
  95. The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
  96. in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
  97. devices.
  98. It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
  99. a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
  100. electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
  101. required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
  102. usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
  103. needed to hook up to the target.
  104. Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
  105. each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
  106. different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
  107. are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
  108. they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
  109. These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
  110. may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
  111. Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
  112. let the development board connect directly to the debug
  113. host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
  114. For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
  115. signaling, and is used to communicate
  116. with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
  117. A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
  118. special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
  119. between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
  120. scan operations.
  121. There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
  122. signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
  123. adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
  124. debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
  125. For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
  126. special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
  127. support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
  128. (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
  129. @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
  130. USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
  131. OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
  132. @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
  133. ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
  134. (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
  135. Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
  136. @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
  137. CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
  138. internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
  139. STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
  140. controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
  141. @section OpenOCD Web Site
  142. The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
  143. @uref{http://openocd.org/}
  144. @section Latest User's Guide:
  145. The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
  146. available. A version for more recent code may be available.
  147. Its HTML form is published regularly at:
  148. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
  149. PDF form is likewise published at:
  150. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
  151. @section OpenOCD User's Forum
  152. There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
  153. which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
  154. anything to come to the attention of developers, you
  155. should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
  156. instead of this forum.
  157. @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
  158. @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
  159. The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
  160. communication between users:
  161. @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
  162. @section OpenOCD IRC
  163. Support can also be found on irc:
  164. @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
  165. @node Developers
  166. @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
  167. @cindex developers
  168. If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
  169. testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
  170. can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
  171. documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
  172. The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
  173. or expand the OpenOCD source code.
  174. @section OpenOCD Git Repository
  175. During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
  176. a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
  177. @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
  178. or via http
  179. @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
  180. You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
  181. @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
  182. With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
  183. a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
  184. There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
  185. with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
  186. needing a Git client:
  187. @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
  188. The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
  189. from the repository or a snapshot.
  190. Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
  191. @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
  192. Patches created against older versions may require additional
  193. work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
  194. @section Doxygen Developer Manual
  195. During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
  196. providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
  197. technical information about the software internals, development
  198. processes, and similar documentation:
  199. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
  200. This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
  201. to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
  202. listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
  203. @section Gerrit Review System
  204. All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
  205. Code Review System:
  206. @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
  207. After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
  208. from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
  209. All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
  210. for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
  211. eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
  212. The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
  213. Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
  214. repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
  215. maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
  216. necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
  217. @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
  218. The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
  219. communication between developers:
  220. @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
  221. @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
  222. The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
  223. @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
  224. @node Debug Adapter Hardware
  225. @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
  226. @cindex dongles
  227. @cindex FTDI
  228. @cindex wiggler
  229. @cindex zy1000
  230. @cindex printer port
  231. @cindex USB Adapter
  232. @cindex RTCK
  233. Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
  234. an adapter .... [snip]
  235. In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
  236. attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
  237. exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
  238. attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
  239. require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
  240. a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
  241. and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
  242. @section Choosing a Dongle
  243. There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
  244. @enumerate
  245. @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
  246. OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
  247. other ways to communicate with target devices.
  248. @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
  249. Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
  250. @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
  251. Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
  252. wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
  253. @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
  254. Ethernet port needed?
  255. @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
  256. RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
  257. @end enumerate
  258. @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
  259. The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
  260. stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
  261. running on the developer's host computer.
  262. Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
  263. access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
  264. IP address assigned to the probe.
  265. The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
  266. OpenOCD debugger.
  267. Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
  268. of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
  269. the target.
  270. The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
  271. to power cycle the target remotely.
  272. For more information, visit:
  273. @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
  274. @section USB FT2232 Based
  275. There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
  276. on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
  277. known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
  278. See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
  279. In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
  280. chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
  281. variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
  282. (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
  283. clocking.)
  284. The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
  285. transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
  286. program some chips. They have two communications channels,
  287. and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
  288. other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
  289. Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
  290. a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
  291. @itemize @bullet
  292. @item @b{usbjtag}
  293. @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
  294. @item @b{jtagkey}
  295. @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
  296. @item @b{jtagkey2}
  297. @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
  298. @item @b{oocdlink}
  299. @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
  300. @item @b{signalyzer}
  301. @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
  302. @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
  303. @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
  304. bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
  305. the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
  306. These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
  307. to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
  308. @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
  309. @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
  310. Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
  311. Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
  312. Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
  313. @item @b{olimex-jtag}
  314. @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
  315. @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
  316. @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
  317. @item @b{turtelizer2}
  318. @* See:
  319. @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
  320. @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
  321. @item @b{comstick}
  322. @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
  323. @item @b{stm32stick}
  324. @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
  325. @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
  326. @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
  327. to be available anymore as of April 2012.
  328. @item @b{cortino}
  329. @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
  330. @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
  331. @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
  332. @item @b{digilent-hs1}
  333. @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
  334. @item @b{opendous}
  335. @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
  336. (OpenHardware).
  337. @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
  338. @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
  339. @item @b{GW16042}
  340. @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
  341. FT2232H-based
  342. @end itemize
  343. @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
  344. These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
  345. protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
  346. protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
  347. of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
  348. or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
  349. They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
  350. product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
  351. (see the section on driver commands).
  352. @itemize
  353. @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
  354. @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
  355. @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
  356. @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
  357. @end itemize
  358. @section USB J-Link based
  359. There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
  360. an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
  361. AT91SAM764 internally.
  362. @itemize @bullet
  363. @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
  364. @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
  365. @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
  366. @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
  367. @item @b{IAR J-Link}
  368. @end itemize
  369. @section USB RLINK based
  370. Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
  371. permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
  372. SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
  373. @itemize @bullet
  374. @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
  375. @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
  376. @item @b{STM32 Primer}
  377. @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
  378. @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
  379. @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
  380. @end itemize
  381. @section USB ST-LINK based
  382. STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
  383. They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
  384. @itemize @bullet
  385. @item @b{ST-LINK}
  386. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
  387. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
  388. @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
  389. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
  390. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
  391. @item @b{STLINK-V3}
  392. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
  393. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
  394. @end itemize
  395. For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
  396. its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
  397. The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
  398. @itemize @bullet
  399. @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
  400. @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
  401. @end itemize
  402. @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
  403. Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
  404. It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
  405. evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
  406. @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
  407. ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
  408. debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
  409. @section USB Other
  410. @itemize @bullet
  411. @item @b{USBprog}
  412. @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
  413. @item @b{USB - Presto}
  414. @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
  415. @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
  416. @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
  417. @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
  418. @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
  419. @item @b{Buspirate}
  420. @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
  421. @item @b{opendous}
  422. @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
  423. @item @b{estick}
  424. @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
  425. @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
  426. @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
  427. @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
  428. @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
  429. LaunchPad evaluation boards.
  430. @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
  431. stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
  432. board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
  433. @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
  434. off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
  435. to 3600 millivolts.
  436. @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
  437. @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
  438. @end itemize
  439. @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
  440. The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
  441. and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
  442. these on the market.
  443. Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
  444. have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
  445. of USB-based ones.
  446. @itemize @bullet
  447. @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
  448. @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
  449. @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
  450. @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
  451. produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
  452. @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
  453. @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
  454. @item @b{Wiggler2}
  455. @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
  456. @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
  457. @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
  458. @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
  459. @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
  460. @item @b{arm-jtag}
  461. @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
  462. @item @b{chameleon}
  463. @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
  464. @item @b{Triton}
  465. @* Unknown.
  466. @item @b{Lattice}
  467. @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
  468. @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
  469. @item @b{flashlink}
  470. @* From STMicroelectronics;
  471. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
  472. @end itemize
  473. @section Other...
  474. @itemize @bullet
  475. @item @b{ep93xx}
  476. @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
  477. @item @b{at91rm9200}
  478. @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
  479. @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
  480. @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
  481. @item @b{imx_gpio}
  482. @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
  483. @item @b{jtag_vpi}
  484. @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
  485. @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
  486. @end itemize
  487. @node About Jim-Tcl
  488. @chapter About Jim-Tcl
  489. @cindex Jim-Tcl
  490. @cindex tcl
  491. OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
  492. This programming language provides a simple and extensible
  493. command interpreter.
  494. All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
  495. You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
  496. much of anything about Tcl.
  497. Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
  498. You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
  499. There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
  500. if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
  501. OpenOCD mailing list.
  502. @itemize @bullet
  503. @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
  504. @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
  505. which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
  506. fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
  507. implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
  508. 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
  509. @item @b{Missing Features}
  510. @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
  511. needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
  512. are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
  513. enabled in OpenOCD.
  514. @item @b{Scripts}
  515. @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
  516. command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
  517. Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
  518. @item @b{Commands}
  519. @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
  520. can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
  521. Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
  522. as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
  523. @item @b{Historical Note}
  524. @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
  525. before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
  526. as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
  527. to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
  528. @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
  529. @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
  530. @end itemize
  531. @node Running
  532. @chapter Running
  533. @cindex command line options
  534. @cindex logfile
  535. @cindex directory search
  536. Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
  537. to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
  538. in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
  539. that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
  540. @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
  541. complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
  542. are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
  543. Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
  544. tell it how each debug session should work.
  545. The @option{--help} option shows:
  546. @verbatim
  547. bash$ openocd --help
  548. --help | -h display this help
  549. --version | -v display OpenOCD version
  550. --file | -f use configuration file <name>
  551. --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
  552. --debug | -d set debug level to 3
  553. | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
  554. --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
  555. --command | -c run <command>
  556. @end verbatim
  557. If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
  558. OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
  559. To specify one or more different
  560. configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
  561. @example
  562. openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
  563. @end example
  564. Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
  565. @enumerate
  566. @item the current directory,
  567. @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
  568. @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
  569. @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
  570. @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
  571. @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
  572. @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
  573. @end enumerate
  574. The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
  575. @quotation Note
  576. Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
  577. include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
  578. @end quotation
  579. @section Simple setup, no customization
  580. In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
  581. libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
  582. your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
  583. start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
  584. customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
  585. If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
  586. target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
  587. the server with some variation of one of the following:
  588. @example
  589. openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
  590. openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
  591. @end example
  592. You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
  593. using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
  594. If all goes well you'll see output something like
  595. @example
  596. Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
  597. For bug reports, read
  598. http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
  599. Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
  600. (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
  601. @end example
  602. Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
  603. the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
  604. you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
  605. @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
  606. OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
  607. on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
  608. @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
  609. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
  610. At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
  611. chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
  612. ensure that this always succeeds.
  613. Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
  614. Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
  615. stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
  616. and then shut down without acting as a server.
  617. Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
  618. clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
  619. those channels.
  620. If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
  621. the @option{-d} option.
  622. Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
  623. @option{-c} command line switch.
  624. To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
  625. itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
  626. @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
  627. including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
  628. informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
  629. setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
  630. (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
  631. You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
  632. @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
  633. Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
  634. establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
  635. the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
  636. correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
  637. @node OpenOCD Project Setup
  638. @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
  639. To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
  640. just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
  641. and start the OpenOCD server.
  642. You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
  643. about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
  644. You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
  645. using Eclipse or some other GUI.
  646. @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
  647. Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
  648. (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
  649. and a USB cable on the other.
  650. Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
  651. older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
  652. @enumerate
  653. @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
  654. and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
  655. If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
  656. It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
  657. unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
  658. galvanic isolation between the target board and the
  659. debugging host.
  660. @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
  661. If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
  662. of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
  663. boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
  664. connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
  665. In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
  666. Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
  667. with 1.2 Volt boards.
  668. @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
  669. damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
  670. ways to connect the cable.
  671. Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
  672. Be sure it's firmly connected.
  673. In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
  674. prevent you from inserting it wrong.
  675. This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
  676. housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
  677. If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
  678. make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
  679. Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
  680. edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
  681. Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
  682. color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
  683. These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
  684. but are tedious to set up.
  685. Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
  686. adapter signals to the right board pins.
  687. @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
  688. A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
  689. you are using to run OpenOCD.
  690. For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
  691. For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
  692. does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
  693. Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
  694. MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
  695. @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
  696. This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
  697. but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
  698. @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
  699. Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
  700. you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
  701. so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
  702. @end enumerate
  703. Talk with the OpenOCD server using
  704. telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
  705. @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
  706. @section Project Directory
  707. There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
  708. A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
  709. single directory for your work with a given board.
  710. When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
  711. it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
  712. files accessed through semihosting,
  713. and for code you upload to the target board.
  714. It is also the natural place to write files,
  715. such as log files and data you download from the board.
  716. @section Configuration Basics
  717. There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
  718. a variety of ways you can mix them.
  719. Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
  720. @itemize
  721. @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
  722. @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
  723. in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
  724. @end itemize
  725. Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
  726. using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
  727. a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
  728. @example
  729. source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
  730. # GDB can also flash my flash!
  731. gdb_memory_map enable
  732. gdb_flash_program enable
  733. source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
  734. @end example
  735. Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
  736. @example
  737. openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
  738. -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
  739. -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
  740. -f target/sam7x256.cfg
  741. @end example
  742. You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
  743. each supporting a different development task.
  744. One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
  745. Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
  746. @quotation Important
  747. At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
  748. problems with how it treats variables.
  749. For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
  750. same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
  751. that can be tested in a later script.
  752. @end quotation
  753. Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
  754. file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
  755. to simplify your work.
  756. @section User Config Files
  757. @cindex config file, user
  758. @cindex user config file
  759. @cindex config file, overview
  760. A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
  761. in one place.
  762. One of the following will match your situation best:
  763. @itemize
  764. @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
  765. provided by someone else.
  766. For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
  767. (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
  768. Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
  769. user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
  770. where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
  771. The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
  772. Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
  773. own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
  774. @enumerate
  775. @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
  776. @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
  777. @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
  778. @end enumerate
  779. Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
  780. The first is an interface config file.
  781. The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
  782. their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
  783. declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
  784. meet your deadline:
  785. @example
  786. source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
  787. source [find board/csb337.cfg]
  788. @end example
  789. Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
  790. than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
  791. That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
  792. the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
  793. @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
  794. Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
  795. need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
  796. Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
  797. target and board
  798. configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
  799. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  800. @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
  801. need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
  802. You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
  803. and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
  804. For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
  805. and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
  806. giving access to your particular flash chips.
  807. Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
  808. for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
  809. @quotation Note
  810. When you write new configuration files, please submit
  811. them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
  812. For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
  813. next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
  814. will help support users of any board using that chip.
  815. @end quotation
  816. @item
  817. You may may need to write some C code.
  818. It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
  819. based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
  820. controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
  821. a new chip architecture.
  822. @end itemize
  823. Reuse the existing config files when you can.
  824. Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
  825. You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
  826. When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
  827. (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
  828. from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
  829. @itemize
  830. @item
  831. For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
  832. the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
  833. early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
  834. that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
  835. @item
  836. Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
  837. @cindex vector_catch
  838. its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
  839. and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
  840. during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
  841. Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
  842. along with messaging and tracing setup.
  843. (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
  844. @item
  845. You might need to override some defaults.
  846. For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
  847. work area if your application needs much SRAM.
  848. @item
  849. TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
  850. is environment-specific, and should only appear in
  851. a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
  852. @end itemize
  853. @section Project-Specific Utilities
  854. A few project-specific utility
  855. routines may well speed up your work.
  856. Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
  857. For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
  858. board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
  859. loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
  860. code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
  861. A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
  862. may help:
  863. @example
  864. proc ramboot @{ @} @{
  865. # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
  866. # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
  867. # Leave the CPU halted.
  868. reset init
  869. # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
  870. load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
  871. # Start running.
  872. resume 0x20000000
  873. @}
  874. @end example
  875. Then once that code is working you will need to make it
  876. boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
  877. Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
  878. (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
  879. based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
  880. @example
  881. proc newboot @{ @} @{
  882. # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
  883. # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
  884. # "reset halt" would be slower.
  885. reset init
  886. # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
  887. # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
  888. # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
  889. flash protect 0 0 1 off
  890. flash erase_sector 0 0 1
  891. flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
  892. flash protect 0 0 1 on
  893. # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
  894. reset run
  895. @}
  896. @end example
  897. You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
  898. from NAND.
  899. That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
  900. running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
  901. the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
  902. Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
  903. involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
  904. @section Target Software Changes
  905. Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
  906. you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
  907. For example, in C or assembly language code you might
  908. use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
  909. handling issues like:
  910. @itemize @bullet
  911. @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
  912. Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
  913. some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
  914. assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
  915. When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
  916. and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
  917. your debug sessions.
  918. It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
  919. needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
  920. That might however be your only option.
  921. Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
  922. while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
  923. that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
  924. need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
  925. damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
  926. involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
  927. at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
  928. and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
  929. protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
  930. that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
  931. it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
  932. instead of the whole thing.
  933. At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
  934. monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
  935. @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
  936. @cindex ARM semihosting
  937. When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
  938. toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
  939. @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
  940. ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
  941. The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
  942. your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
  943. provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
  944. It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
  945. helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
  946. for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
  947. NAND or SPI flash.
  948. @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
  949. Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
  950. Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
  951. Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
  952. via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
  953. You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
  954. or otherwise prevent using that state,
  955. to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
  956. polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
  957. registers which can be used to change various features including
  958. how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
  959. The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
  960. power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
  961. For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
  962. work for an idle processor otherwise.
  963. @item @b{Delay after reset}...
  964. Not all chips have good support for debugger access
  965. right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
  966. Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
  967. JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
  968. To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
  969. the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
  970. For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
  971. time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
  972. early code execution can be debugged
  973. or firmware can be replaced.
  974. @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
  975. Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
  976. Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
  977. (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
  978. operations like writing to memory.)
  979. Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
  980. over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
  981. provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
  982. various kinds of message.
  983. @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
  984. @end itemize
  985. @section Target Hardware Setup
  986. Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
  987. are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
  988. that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
  989. jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
  990. working with.}
  991. Common issues include:
  992. @itemize @bullet
  993. @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
  994. Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
  995. Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
  996. on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
  997. (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
  998. or one from a daughtercard).
  999. For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
  1000. EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
  1001. @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
  1002. Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
  1003. by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
  1004. For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
  1005. to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
  1006. using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
  1007. Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
  1008. booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
  1009. start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
  1010. SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
  1011. flash; some external host; or various other sources.
  1012. @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
  1013. Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
  1014. to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
  1015. external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
  1016. a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
  1017. or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
  1018. board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
  1019. Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
  1020. configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
  1021. using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
  1022. @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
  1023. its @code{reset-init} handler.
  1024. A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
  1025. distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
  1026. used to start booting.
  1027. @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
  1028. Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
  1029. on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
  1030. multiple audio codec chips).
  1031. This interacts with software
  1032. configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
  1033. given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
  1034. or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
  1035. configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
  1036. signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
  1037. might in turn affect booting); others might control which
  1038. audio or video codecs are used.
  1039. @end itemize
  1040. Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
  1041. which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
  1042. That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
  1043. the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
  1044. memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
  1045. able to access those resources without working target firmware
  1046. which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
  1047. trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
  1048. bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
  1049. access to all board-specific capabilities.
  1050. @node Config File Guidelines
  1051. @chapter Config File Guidelines
  1052. This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
  1053. including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
  1054. needs to get a new board working smoothly.
  1055. It provides guidelines for creating those files.
  1056. You should find the following directories under
  1057. @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
  1058. them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
  1059. @itemize @bullet
  1060. @item @file{interface} ...
  1061. These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
  1062. specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
  1063. @item @file{board} ...
  1064. Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
  1065. contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
  1066. They reuse target configuration files, since the same
  1067. microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
  1068. but support for external parts varies widely. For
  1069. example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
  1070. of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
  1071. sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
  1072. board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
  1073. a CPU and an FPGA.
  1074. @item @file{target} ...
  1075. Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
  1076. on a chip
  1077. which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
  1078. are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
  1079. When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
  1080. the target config file defines all of them.
  1081. @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
  1082. For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
  1083. @end itemize
  1084. The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
  1085. file may override features in any of the above files by
  1086. setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
  1087. commands specific to their situation.
  1088. @section Interface Config Files
  1089. The user config file
  1090. should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
  1091. @example
  1092. source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1093. @end example
  1094. A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
  1095. in use today with OpenOCD.
  1096. That said, perhaps some of these config files
  1097. have only been used by the developer who created it.
  1098. A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
  1099. @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
  1100. Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
  1101. if you have a new kind of hardware interface
  1102. and need to provide a driver for it.
  1103. @section Board Config Files
  1104. @cindex config file, board
  1105. @cindex board config file
  1106. The user config file
  1107. should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
  1108. @example
  1109. source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1110. @end example
  1111. The point of a board config file is to package everything
  1112. about a given board that user config files need to know.
  1113. In summary the board files should contain (if present)
  1114. @enumerate
  1115. @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
  1116. @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
  1117. @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
  1118. @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
  1119. @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
  1120. @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
  1121. @end enumerate
  1122. Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
  1123. not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
  1124. handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
  1125. which it passes to target-specific utility code.
  1126. The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
  1127. @code{reset-init} event handler.
  1128. Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
  1129. configuration works.
  1130. @subsection Communication Between Config files
  1131. In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
  1132. board and target config files communicate is by following a
  1133. convention on how to use certain variables.
  1134. The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
  1135. Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
  1136. a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
  1137. used at will within a target configuration file.
  1138. Complex board config files can do the things like this,
  1139. for a board with three chips:
  1140. @example
  1141. # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
  1142. set CHIPNAME network
  1143. set ENDIAN big
  1144. source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
  1145. # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
  1146. # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
  1147. $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
  1148. # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
  1149. set CHIPNAME video
  1150. set ENDIAN little
  1151. source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
  1152. # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
  1153. # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
  1154. $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
  1155. # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
  1156. set CHIPNAME xilinx
  1157. unset ENDIAN
  1158. source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
  1159. @end example
  1160. That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
  1161. or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
  1162. or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
  1163. Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
  1164. where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
  1165. not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
  1166. is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
  1167. have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
  1168. Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
  1169. config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
  1170. naming collisions.
  1171. Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
  1172. For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
  1173. what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
  1174. up other clocks and peripherals.
  1175. @subsection Variable Naming Convention
  1176. @cindex variable names
  1177. Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
  1178. However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
  1179. one such chip (as shown above).
  1180. Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
  1181. variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
  1182. to promote consistency and
  1183. so that board files can override target defaults.
  1184. Inputs to target config files include:
  1185. @itemize @bullet
  1186. @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
  1187. This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
  1188. tap identifier dotted names.
  1189. While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
  1190. board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
  1191. @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
  1192. By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
  1193. Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
  1194. @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
  1195. When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
  1196. chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
  1197. The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
  1198. chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
  1199. @end itemize
  1200. Outputs from target config files include:
  1201. @itemize @bullet
  1202. @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
  1203. By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
  1204. script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
  1205. configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
  1206. specific to that board and that target.
  1207. If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
  1208. @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
  1209. @end itemize
  1210. @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
  1211. @cindex event, reset-init
  1212. @cindex reset-init handler
  1213. Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
  1214. they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
  1215. fully set up yet.
  1216. This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
  1217. you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
  1218. That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
  1219. handler is one of the most important.
  1220. Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
  1221. handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
  1222. Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
  1223. on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
  1224. handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
  1225. @quotation Note
  1226. Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
  1227. are included here.
  1228. Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
  1229. If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
  1230. configuration files for other JTAG tools
  1231. (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
  1232. @end quotation
  1233. Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
  1234. For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
  1235. much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
  1236. reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
  1237. those as parameters.
  1238. Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
  1239. and disabling the watchdog.
  1240. Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
  1241. the next developer doing such work.
  1242. (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
  1243. The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
  1244. whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
  1245. done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
  1246. access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
  1247. @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
  1248. Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
  1249. the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
  1250. a low JTAG clock rate.
  1251. @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
  1252. Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
  1253. made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
  1254. When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
  1255. because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
  1256. you should probably set it up in the board config file;
  1257. if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
  1258. For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
  1259. @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
  1260. is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
  1261. Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
  1262. which might be less than that.
  1263. @quotation Warning
  1264. On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
  1265. software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
  1266. Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
  1267. solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
  1268. @end quotation
  1269. If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
  1270. use the @command{jtag_rclk}
  1271. command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
  1272. also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
  1273. Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
  1274. and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
  1275. @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
  1276. @subsection The init_board procedure
  1277. @cindex init_board procedure
  1278. The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
  1279. (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
  1280. configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
  1281. (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
  1282. separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
  1283. everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
  1284. everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
  1285. Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
  1286. @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
  1287. so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
  1288. problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
  1289. need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
  1290. Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
  1291. the original), allowing greater code reuse.
  1292. @example
  1293. ### board_file.cfg ###
  1294. # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
  1295. source [find target/target.cfg]
  1296. proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
  1297. # enables fast on-board clock source
  1298. # configures the chip to use it
  1299. @}
  1300. # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
  1301. proc init_board @{@} @{
  1302. reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
  1303. $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
  1304. adapter_khz 100
  1305. @}
  1306. $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
  1307. enable_fast_clock
  1308. adapter_khz 10000
  1309. @}
  1310. @}
  1311. @end example
  1312. @section Target Config Files
  1313. @cindex config file, target
  1314. @cindex target config file
  1315. Board config files communicate with target config files using
  1316. naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
  1317. more target config files like this:
  1318. @example
  1319. source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1320. @end example
  1321. The point of a target config file is to package everything
  1322. about a given chip that board config files need to know.
  1323. In summary the target files should contain
  1324. @enumerate
  1325. @item Set defaults
  1326. @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
  1327. @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
  1328. @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
  1329. @item On-Chip flash
  1330. @end enumerate
  1331. As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
  1332. For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
  1333. which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
  1334. More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
  1335. config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
  1336. can talk to the chip.
  1337. For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
  1338. an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
  1339. another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
  1340. and other processing engines.
  1341. @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
  1342. All target configuration files should start with code like this,
  1343. letting board config files express environment-specific
  1344. differences in how things should be set up.
  1345. @example
  1346. # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
  1347. # but the default should match what the vendor uses
  1348. if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
  1349. set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
  1350. @} else @{
  1351. set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
  1352. @}
  1353. # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
  1354. if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
  1355. set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
  1356. @} else @{
  1357. set _ENDIAN little
  1358. @}
  1359. # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
  1360. # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
  1361. # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
  1362. if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
  1363. set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
  1364. @} else @{
  1365. set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
  1366. @}
  1367. @end example
  1368. @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
  1369. @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
  1370. config files, or the same target file multiple times
  1371. (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
  1372. Likewise, the target configuration file should define
  1373. @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
  1374. use it later on when defining debug targets:
  1375. @example
  1376. set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
  1377. target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
  1378. @end example
  1379. @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
  1380. After the ``defaults'' are set up,
  1381. add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
  1382. @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
  1383. for taps.
  1384. In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
  1385. probably for a CPU or FPGA.
  1386. The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
  1387. looks (in part) like this:
  1388. @example
  1389. jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
  1390. @end example
  1391. A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
  1392. to source such a config file twice, with different
  1393. values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
  1394. it adds a different TAP each time.
  1395. If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
  1396. OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
  1397. It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
  1398. can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
  1399. @example
  1400. JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
  1401. (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
  1402. ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
  1403. ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
  1404. ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
  1405. @end example
  1406. There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
  1407. multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
  1408. @itemize
  1409. @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
  1410. plus a JRC to enable them
  1411. @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
  1412. @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
  1413. is not currently used)
  1414. @end itemize
  1415. @subsection Add CPU targets
  1416. After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
  1417. GDB and other commands can use it.
  1418. @xref{CPU Configuration}.
  1419. For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
  1420. note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
  1421. to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
  1422. @example
  1423. set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
  1424. target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
  1425. @end example
  1426. Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
  1427. They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
  1428. and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
  1429. If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
  1430. a work area if you can.
  1431. Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
  1432. @example
  1433. $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
  1434. -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
  1435. @end example
  1436. @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
  1437. @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
  1438. @cindex SMP
  1439. After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
  1440. @example
  1441. set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
  1442. set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
  1443. target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
  1444. -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
  1445. target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
  1446. -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
  1447. #define 2 targets working in smp.
  1448. target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
  1449. @end example
  1450. In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
  1451. In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
  1452. @itemize @bullet
  1453. @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
  1454. @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
  1455. @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
  1456. @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
  1457. @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
  1458. displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
  1459. @end itemize
  1460. The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
  1461. command have been implemented.
  1462. @itemize @bullet
  1463. @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
  1464. @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
  1465. displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
  1466. session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
  1467. @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
  1468. @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
  1469. following example.
  1470. @end itemize
  1471. @example
  1472. >cortex_a smp_gdb
  1473. gdb coreid 0 -> -1
  1474. #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
  1475. #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
  1476. > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
  1477. gdb coreid 0 -> 1
  1478. #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
  1479. #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
  1480. > resume
  1481. > cortex_a smp_gdb
  1482. gdb coreid 1 -> 1
  1483. #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
  1484. #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
  1485. > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
  1486. gdb coreid 1 -> -1
  1487. #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
  1488. #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
  1489. @end example
  1490. @subsection Chip Reset Setup
  1491. As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
  1492. into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
  1493. chip can be tweaked by the board.
  1494. Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
  1495. managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
  1496. and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
  1497. For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
  1498. both signals.
  1499. Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
  1500. Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
  1501. letting this target config be used in systems which don't
  1502. provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
  1503. don't want to reset all targets at once.
  1504. Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
  1505. use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
  1506. or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
  1507. (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
  1508. driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
  1509. not available.)
  1510. Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
  1511. they're going to be used with JTAG.
  1512. An example might be needing to send some commands right
  1513. after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
  1514. @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
  1515. register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
  1516. Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
  1517. counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
  1518. JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
  1519. some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
  1520. are the right places to handle some of those issues.
  1521. For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
  1522. slower clock than they will use later.
  1523. That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
  1524. first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
  1525. than they will use later.
  1526. @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
  1527. @quotation Important
  1528. When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
  1529. reset, getting these issues right is critical.
  1530. In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
  1531. OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
  1532. look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
  1533. @end quotation
  1534. @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
  1535. @subsection The init_targets procedure
  1536. @cindex init_targets procedure
  1537. Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
  1538. configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
  1539. procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
  1540. (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
  1541. Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
  1542. This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
  1543. procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
  1544. a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
  1545. because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
  1546. @example
  1547. ### generic_file.cfg ###
  1548. proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
  1549. # basic initialization procedure ...
  1550. @}
  1551. proc init_targets @{@} @{
  1552. # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
  1553. setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
  1554. @}
  1555. ### specific_file.cfg ###
  1556. source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
  1557. proc init_targets @{@} @{
  1558. # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
  1559. setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
  1560. @}
  1561. @end example
  1562. The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
  1563. enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
  1564. For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
  1565. The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
  1566. (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
  1567. @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
  1568. @subsection The init_target_events procedure
  1569. @cindex init_target_events procedure
  1570. A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
  1571. @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
  1572. procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
  1573. (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
  1574. to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
  1575. events already assigned.
  1576. @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
  1577. If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
  1578. special high speed download features - enable it.
  1579. If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
  1580. Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
  1581. examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
  1582. activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
  1583. on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
  1584. through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
  1585. If you are using an external trace port,
  1586. configure it in your board config file.
  1587. If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
  1588. configure it in your target config file.
  1589. @example
  1590. etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
  1591. etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
  1592. @end example
  1593. @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
  1594. This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
  1595. @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
  1596. flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
  1597. Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
  1598. the TARGET (chip) file.
  1599. Examples:
  1600. @itemize @bullet
  1601. @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
  1602. @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
  1603. @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
  1604. @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
  1605. @end itemize
  1606. @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
  1607. @section Translating Configuration Files
  1608. @cindex translation
  1609. If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
  1610. or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
  1611. Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
  1612. it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
  1613. part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
  1614. sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
  1615. One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
  1616. Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
  1617. can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
  1618. convert other scripts later on.
  1619. Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
  1620. replace job:
  1621. @example
  1622. # Lauterbach syntax(?)
  1623. #
  1624. # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
  1625. #
  1626. # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
  1627. #
  1628. # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
  1629. proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
  1630. global TARGETNAME
  1631. echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
  1632. arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
  1633. [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
  1634. [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
  1635. @}
  1636. @end example
  1637. @node Server Configuration
  1638. @chapter Server Configuration
  1639. @cindex initialization
  1640. The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
  1641. used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
  1642. supported.
  1643. @anchor{configurationstage}
  1644. @section Configuration Stage
  1645. @cindex configuration stage
  1646. @cindex config command
  1647. When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
  1648. @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
  1649. certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
  1650. Normally, configuration commands are only available
  1651. inside startup scripts.
  1652. In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
  1653. presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
  1654. which may be issued interactively.
  1655. The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
  1656. commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
  1657. Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
  1658. flash banks,
  1659. the interface used for JTAG communication,
  1660. and other basic setup.
  1661. The server must leave the configuration stage before it
  1662. may access or activate TAPs.
  1663. After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
  1664. longer be issued.
  1665. @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
  1666. @section Entering the Run Stage
  1667. The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
  1668. stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
  1669. (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
  1670. It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
  1671. or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
  1672. You should see no errors at this point.
  1673. If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
  1674. commands you used to configure the server.
  1675. Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
  1676. fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
  1677. on the scan chain.
  1678. Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
  1679. become available.
  1680. A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
  1681. For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
  1682. a target has been successfully instantiated.
  1683. If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
  1684. entry to the run stage.
  1685. @deffn {Config Command} init
  1686. This command terminates the configuration stage and
  1687. enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
  1688. the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
  1689. programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
  1690. "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
  1691. command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
  1692. If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
  1693. OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
  1694. configuration files and/or command line options.
  1695. @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
  1696. openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
  1697. targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
  1698. read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
  1699. the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
  1700. @end deffn
  1701. @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
  1702. This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
  1703. to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
  1704. The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
  1705. which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
  1706. scan chain.
  1707. If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
  1708. from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
  1709. Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
  1710. they return.
  1711. This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
  1712. (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
  1713. @end deffn
  1714. @anchor{tcpipports}
  1715. @section TCP/IP Ports
  1716. @cindex TCP port
  1717. @cindex server
  1718. @cindex port
  1719. @cindex security
  1720. The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
  1721. Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
  1722. only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
  1723. For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
  1724. access using one or more of these ports.
  1725. In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
  1726. If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
  1727. use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
  1728. @anchor{gdb_port}
  1729. @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
  1730. @cindex GDB server
  1731. Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
  1732. communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
  1733. "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
  1734. the normal use cases.
  1735. No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
  1736. output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
  1737. disables the gdb server.
  1738. When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
  1739. output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
  1740. The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
  1741. as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
  1742. Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
  1743. Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
  1744. e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
  1745. The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
  1746. second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
  1747. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1748. the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
  1749. When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
  1750. the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
  1751. @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
  1752. commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
  1753. @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
  1754. Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
  1755. gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
  1756. cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
  1757. @end deffn
  1758. @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
  1759. Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
  1760. connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
  1761. output from the Tcl engine.
  1762. Intended as a machine interface.
  1763. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1764. the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
  1765. When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
  1766. @end deffn
  1767. @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
  1768. Specify or query the
  1769. port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
  1770. This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
  1771. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1772. the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
  1773. When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
  1774. @end deffn
  1775. @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
  1776. @section GDB Configuration
  1777. @cindex GDB
  1778. @cindex GDB configuration
  1779. You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
  1780. The ones listed here are static and global.
  1781. @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
  1782. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
  1783. @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
  1784. @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
  1785. Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
  1786. This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
  1787. distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
  1788. GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
  1789. breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
  1790. @end deffn
  1791. @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
  1792. @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1793. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
  1794. vFlash packet is received.
  1795. The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1796. @end deffn
  1797. @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1798. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
  1799. requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
  1800. using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
  1801. for flash programming to work.
  1802. Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1803. @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
  1804. @end deffn
  1805. @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1806. Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
  1807. by GDB memory read packets.
  1808. The default behaviour is @option{disable};
  1809. use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
  1810. @end deffn
  1811. @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1812. Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
  1813. packets report errors or not.
  1814. The default behaviour is @option{disable};
  1815. use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
  1816. @end deffn
  1817. @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1818. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
  1819. The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1820. @end deffn
  1821. @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
  1822. Saves the target description file to the local file system.
  1823. The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
  1824. @end deffn
  1825. @anchor{eventpolling}
  1826. @section Event Polling
  1827. Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
  1828. where significant events can happen at any time.
  1829. The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
  1830. so it can report them to through TCL command line
  1831. or to GDB.
  1832. Examples of such events include:
  1833. @itemize
  1834. @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
  1835. a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
  1836. @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
  1837. targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
  1838. for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
  1839. @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
  1840. @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
  1841. can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
  1842. including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
  1843. @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
  1844. such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
  1845. or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
  1846. @end itemize
  1847. None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
  1848. However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
  1849. level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
  1850. Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
  1851. can imply events when those signals are inputs.
  1852. In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
  1853. either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
  1854. or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
  1855. to the various active targets.
  1856. There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
  1857. which is normally done in the background.
  1858. @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  1859. Poll the current target for its current state.
  1860. (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
  1861. If that target is in debug mode, architecture
  1862. specific information about the current state is printed.
  1863. An optional parameter
  1864. allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
  1865. You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
  1866. from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
  1867. Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
  1868. @example
  1869. > poll
  1870. background polling: on
  1871. target state: halted
  1872. target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
  1873. current mode: Supervisor
  1874. cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
  1875. MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
  1876. >
  1877. @end example
  1878. @end deffn
  1879. @node Debug Adapter Configuration
  1880. @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
  1881. @cindex config file, interface
  1882. @cindex interface config file
  1883. Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
  1884. OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
  1885. are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
  1886. @quotation Note
  1887. Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
  1888. places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
  1889. in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
  1890. limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
  1891. Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
  1892. specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
  1893. programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
  1894. @end quotation
  1895. Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
  1896. through commands in an interface configuration
  1897. file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
  1898. through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
  1899. @example
  1900. source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
  1901. @end example
  1902. These commands tell
  1903. OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
  1904. A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
  1905. @example
  1906. # jlink interface
  1907. interface jlink
  1908. @end example
  1909. Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
  1910. @section Interface Configuration
  1911. The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
  1912. using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
  1913. more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
  1914. @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
  1915. Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
  1916. target.
  1917. @end deffn
  1918. @deffn Command {interface_list}
  1919. List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
  1920. the running copy of OpenOCD.
  1921. @end deffn
  1922. @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
  1923. Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
  1924. The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
  1925. when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
  1926. the hardware can support.
  1927. @end deffn
  1928. @deffn Command {adapter_name}
  1929. Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
  1930. @end deffn
  1931. @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
  1932. @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
  1933. Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
  1934. roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
  1935. @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
  1936. @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
  1937. The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
  1938. This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
  1939. @end deffn
  1940. @section Interface Drivers
  1941. Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
  1942. enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
  1943. available at run time.
  1944. @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
  1945. Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
  1946. connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
  1947. This defines some driver-specific commands:
  1948. @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
  1949. Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
  1950. the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  1951. @end deffn
  1952. @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  1953. Displays status of RTCK option.
  1954. Optionally sets that option first.
  1955. @end deffn
  1956. @end deffn
  1957. @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
  1958. Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
  1959. This has one driver-specific command:
  1960. @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
  1961. Logs some status
  1962. @end deffn
  1963. @end deffn
  1964. @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
  1965. Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
  1966. presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
  1967. and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
  1968. @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
  1969. @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
  1970. @end deffn
  1971. @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
  1972. ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
  1973. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  1974. The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
  1975. the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
  1976. Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
  1977. @example
  1978. cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
  1979. @end example
  1980. @end deffn
  1981. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
  1982. Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
  1983. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  1984. @end deffn
  1985. @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
  1986. Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
  1987. @end deffn
  1988. @end deffn
  1989. @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
  1990. A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
  1991. @end deffn
  1992. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
  1993. Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
  1994. @end deffn
  1995. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
  1996. This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
  1997. Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
  1998. The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
  1999. bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
  2000. Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
  2001. configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
  2002. The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
  2003. define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
  2004. controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
  2005. are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
  2006. will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
  2007. @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
  2008. To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
  2009. SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
  2010. the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
  2011. required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
  2012. the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
  2013. Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
  2014. be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
  2015. nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
  2016. signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
  2017. @itemize @minus
  2018. @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
  2019. @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
  2020. @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
  2021. FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
  2022. @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
  2023. switching data and direction as necessary
  2024. @end itemize
  2025. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2026. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2027. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2028. The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
  2029. [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
  2030. @example
  2031. ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
  2032. @end example
  2033. @end deffn
  2034. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
  2035. Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
  2036. of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
  2037. during device selection.
  2038. @end deffn
  2039. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
  2040. Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
  2041. in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
  2042. is connected to the host.
  2043. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2044. (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
  2045. and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
  2046. @end deffn
  2047. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
  2048. @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
  2049. Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
  2050. Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
  2051. roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
  2052. @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
  2053. @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
  2054. The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
  2055. This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
  2056. @end deffn
  2057. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
  2058. Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
  2059. adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
  2060. @end deffn
  2061. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
  2062. Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
  2063. Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
  2064. and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
  2065. schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
  2066. minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
  2067. and initially asserted reset signals.
  2068. @end deffn
  2069. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
  2070. Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
  2071. GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
  2072. register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
  2073. buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
  2074. pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
  2075. used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
  2076. The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
  2077. not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
  2078. @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
  2079. with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
  2080. Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
  2081. simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
  2082. only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
  2083. driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
  2084. it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
  2085. @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
  2086. A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
  2087. same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
  2088. target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
  2089. input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
  2090. characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
  2091. are always driven by the FTDI.
  2092. If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
  2093. identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
  2094. @var{name}.
  2095. @end deffn
  2096. @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
  2097. Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
  2098. @itemize @minus
  2099. @item @option{0}, drive low
  2100. @item @option{1}, drive high
  2101. @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
  2102. @end itemize
  2103. @end deffn
  2104. @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
  2105. Get the value of a previously defined signal.
  2106. @end deffn
  2107. @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
  2108. Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
  2109. Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
  2110. peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
  2111. TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
  2112. stability at higher JTAG clocks.
  2113. @itemize @minus
  2114. @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
  2115. @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
  2116. @end itemize
  2117. @end deffn
  2118. For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
  2119. @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
  2120. @end deffn
  2121. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
  2122. This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
  2123. FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
  2124. It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
  2125. List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
  2126. @itemize @minus
  2127. @item RXD(5) - TDI
  2128. @item TXD(1) - TCK
  2129. @item RTS(3) - TDO
  2130. @item CTS(11) - TMS
  2131. @item DTR(2) - TRST
  2132. @item DCD(10) - SRST
  2133. @end itemize
  2134. User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
  2135. commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
  2136. GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
  2137. They differ from physical pin numbers.
  2138. For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
  2139. Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
  2140. different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
  2141. that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
  2142. FT232R
  2143. @itemize @minus
  2144. @item bit 7 - RI
  2145. @item bit 6 - DCD
  2146. @item bit 5 - DSR
  2147. @item bit 4 - DTR
  2148. @item bit 3 - CTS
  2149. @item bit 2 - RTS
  2150. @item bit 1 - RXD
  2151. @item bit 0 - TXD
  2152. @end itemize
  2153. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2154. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2155. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
  2156. The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
  2157. 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
  2158. @end deffn
  2159. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
  2160. Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
  2161. vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
  2162. the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2163. @end deffn
  2164. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
  2165. Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
  2166. If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
  2167. @end deffn
  2168. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
  2169. Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
  2170. @end deffn
  2171. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
  2172. Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
  2173. @end deffn
  2174. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
  2175. Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
  2176. @end deffn
  2177. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
  2178. Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
  2179. @end deffn
  2180. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
  2181. Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
  2182. @end deffn
  2183. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
  2184. Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
  2185. @end deffn
  2186. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
  2187. Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
  2188. (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
  2189. set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
  2190. 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
  2191. byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
  2192. When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
  2193. Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
  2194. then kernel driver will not reattach.
  2195. If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
  2196. @end deffn
  2197. @end deffn
  2198. @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
  2199. Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
  2200. with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
  2201. instead of directly driving JTAG.
  2202. The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
  2203. processors which are being simulated.
  2204. @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
  2205. Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
  2206. sockets instead of TCP.
  2207. @end deffn
  2208. @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
  2209. Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
  2210. name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
  2211. @end deffn
  2212. For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
  2213. something like:
  2214. @example
  2215. interface remote_bitbang
  2216. remote_bitbang_port 3335
  2217. remote_bitbang_host foobar
  2218. @end example
  2219. To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
  2220. named mysocket:
  2221. @example
  2222. interface remote_bitbang
  2223. remote_bitbang_port 0
  2224. remote_bitbang_host mysocket
  2225. @end example
  2226. @end deffn
  2227. @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
  2228. USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
  2229. for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
  2230. configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2231. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
  2232. Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
  2233. of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
  2234. specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
  2235. if compiled with FTD2XX support.
  2236. @end deffn
  2237. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
  2238. The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
  2239. default values are used.
  2240. Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
  2241. Altera USB-Blaster (default):
  2242. @example
  2243. usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
  2244. @end example
  2245. The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
  2246. @example
  2247. usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
  2248. @end example
  2249. @end deffn
  2250. @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
  2251. Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
  2252. (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
  2253. SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
  2254. target board.
  2255. For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
  2256. @example
  2257. usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
  2258. reset_config srst_only
  2259. @end example
  2260. @end deffn
  2261. @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
  2262. Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
  2263. @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
  2264. configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
  2265. @end deffn
  2266. @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
  2267. This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
  2268. image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
  2269. @end deffn
  2270. @end deffn
  2271. @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
  2272. Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
  2273. This has one driver-specific command:
  2274. @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
  2275. Display either the address of the I/O port
  2276. (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  2277. If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
  2278. This is a write-once setting.
  2279. @end deffn
  2280. @end deffn
  2281. @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
  2282. SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
  2283. transports.
  2284. @quotation Compatibility Note
  2285. SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
  2286. produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
  2287. but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
  2288. recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
  2289. available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
  2290. target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
  2291. released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
  2292. revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
  2293. "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
  2294. version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
  2295. @end quotation
  2296. @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
  2297. Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
  2298. states.
  2299. @end deffn
  2300. @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
  2301. Display free device internal memory.
  2302. @end deffn
  2303. @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
  2304. Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
  2305. command version.
  2306. @end deffn
  2307. @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
  2308. Display the device configuration.
  2309. @end deffn
  2310. @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  2311. Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
  2312. power state.
  2313. @end deffn
  2314. @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
  2315. Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
  2316. @end deffn
  2317. @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
  2318. Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
  2319. bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
  2320. IP configuration.
  2321. @end deffn
  2322. @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
  2323. Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
  2324. (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
  2325. @end deffn
  2326. @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
  2327. Reset the current configuration.
  2328. @end deffn
  2329. @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
  2330. Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
  2331. @end deffn
  2332. @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
  2333. Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
  2334. pairs.
  2335. The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
  2336. the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
  2337. @example
  2338. > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
  2339. @end example
  2340. @end deffn
  2341. @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
  2342. Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
  2343. pairs.
  2344. The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
  2345. @example
  2346. > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
  2347. 77a90000
  2348. @end example
  2349. @end deffn
  2350. @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
  2351. Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
  2352. to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
  2353. selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
  2354. instead.
  2355. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
  2356. @end deffn
  2357. @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
  2358. Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
  2359. connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2360. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
  2361. @end deffn
  2362. @end deffn
  2363. @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
  2364. This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
  2365. SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
  2366. families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
  2367. this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
  2368. @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
  2369. configuration script.
  2370. Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
  2371. mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
  2372. be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
  2373. switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
  2374. instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
  2375. Known limitations:
  2376. @itemize @bullet
  2377. @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
  2378. and 2.7 MHz.
  2379. @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
  2380. "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
  2381. not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
  2382. implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
  2383. versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
  2384. SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
  2385. communications with the target.
  2386. @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
  2387. version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
  2388. communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
  2389. disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
  2390. mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
  2391. could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
  2392. @end itemize
  2393. @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
  2394. Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
  2395. Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
  2396. @end deffn
  2397. @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
  2398. Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
  2399. device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
  2400. @end deffn
  2401. @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
  2402. Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
  2403. outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
  2404. target as a side-effect.
  2405. This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
  2406. @end deffn
  2407. @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
  2408. Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
  2409. version, and target voltage.
  2410. @end deffn
  2411. @end deffn
  2412. @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
  2413. Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
  2414. Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
  2415. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2416. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2417. @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
  2418. Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
  2419. This is a write-once setting.
  2420. Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
  2421. @itemize @minus
  2422. @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
  2423. @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
  2424. TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
  2425. @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
  2426. in configuration mode. This is only used to
  2427. program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
  2428. @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
  2429. @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
  2430. @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
  2431. @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
  2432. some versions of
  2433. Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
  2434. the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
  2435. @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
  2436. ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
  2437. This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
  2438. (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
  2439. @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
  2440. several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
  2441. @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
  2442. @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
  2443. @end itemize
  2444. @end deffn
  2445. @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
  2446. Display either the address of the I/O port
  2447. (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  2448. If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
  2449. This is a write-once setting.
  2450. When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
  2451. @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
  2452. you may encounter a problem.
  2453. @end deffn
  2454. @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
  2455. Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
  2456. the parport driver uses this value to obey the
  2457. @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
  2458. When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
  2459. that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
  2460. The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
  2461. However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
  2462. @quotation Tip
  2463. To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
  2464. oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
  2465. @example
  2466. > parport_toggling_time 1000
  2467. > adapter_khz 500
  2468. @end example
  2469. This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
  2470. the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
  2471. Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
  2472. You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
  2473. large set of samples.
  2474. Update the setting to match your measurement:
  2475. @example
  2476. > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
  2477. @end example
  2478. Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
  2479. commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
  2480. You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
  2481. that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
  2482. seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
  2483. toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
  2484. match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
  2485. @end quotation
  2486. @end deffn
  2487. @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
  2488. This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
  2489. cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
  2490. @end deffn
  2491. For example, the interface configuration file for a
  2492. classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
  2493. @example
  2494. interface parport
  2495. parport_port 0x278
  2496. parport_cable wiggler
  2497. @end example
  2498. @end deffn
  2499. @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
  2500. ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
  2501. @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
  2502. Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
  2503. @end deffn
  2504. @end deffn
  2505. @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
  2506. Raisonance RLink USB adapter
  2507. @end deffn
  2508. @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
  2509. usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
  2510. @end deffn
  2511. @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
  2512. vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
  2513. @quotation Note
  2514. This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
  2515. which are not currently documented here.
  2516. @end quotation
  2517. @end deffn
  2518. @anchor{hla_interface}
  2519. @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
  2520. This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
  2521. This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
  2522. that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
  2523. Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
  2524. ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
  2525. versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
  2526. using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
  2527. version reported is V2.J21.S4.
  2528. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
  2529. Currently Not Supported.
  2530. @end deffn
  2531. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
  2532. Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
  2533. @end deffn
  2534. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
  2535. Specifies the adapter layout to use.
  2536. @end deffn
  2537. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2538. Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
  2539. @end deffn
  2540. @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
  2541. Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
  2542. passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
  2543. @end deffn
  2544. @end deffn
  2545. @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
  2546. @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
  2547. This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
  2548. (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
  2549. directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
  2550. The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
  2551. maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
  2552. (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
  2553. An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
  2554. @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
  2555. also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
  2556. @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
  2557. Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
  2558. @end deffn
  2559. @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2560. Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
  2561. @end deffn
  2562. @end deffn
  2563. @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
  2564. opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
  2565. @end deffn
  2566. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
  2567. This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
  2568. @end deffn
  2569. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
  2570. This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
  2571. @end deffn
  2572. @quotation Note
  2573. This defines some driver-specific commands,
  2574. which are not currently documented here.
  2575. @end quotation
  2576. @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  2577. Turn power switch to target on/off.
  2578. No arguments: print status.
  2579. @end deffn
  2580. @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
  2581. This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
  2582. exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
  2583. The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
  2584. for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
  2585. the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
  2586. able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
  2587. peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
  2588. configuration on exit.
  2589. See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
  2590. pinout.
  2591. @end deffn
  2592. @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
  2593. i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
  2594. of the one which is most popular.
  2595. This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
  2596. See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
  2597. pinout.
  2598. @end deffn
  2599. @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
  2600. OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
  2601. This defines some driver-specific commands:
  2602. @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
  2603. Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
  2604. Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
  2605. @itemize @minus
  2606. @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
  2607. @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
  2608. (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
  2609. @end itemize
  2610. @end deffn
  2611. @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
  2612. The USB device description string of the adapter.
  2613. This value is only used with the standard variant.
  2614. @end deffn
  2615. @end deffn
  2616. @section Transport Configuration
  2617. @cindex Transport
  2618. As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
  2619. and the debug adapter you are using,
  2620. several transports may be available to
  2621. communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
  2622. @deffn Command {transport list}
  2623. displays the names of the transports supported by this
  2624. version of OpenOCD.
  2625. @end deffn
  2626. @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
  2627. Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
  2628. When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
  2629. transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
  2630. hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
  2631. adapter's driver).
  2632. If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
  2633. provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
  2634. supported by the debug adapter.
  2635. @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
  2636. transport, if any.
  2637. @end deffn
  2638. @subsection JTAG Transport
  2639. @cindex JTAG
  2640. JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
  2641. of the OpenOCD commands support it.
  2642. JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
  2643. each of which must be explicitly declared.
  2644. JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
  2645. Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
  2646. JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
  2647. jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
  2648. driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
  2649. or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
  2650. the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
  2651. @subsection SWD Transport
  2652. @cindex SWD
  2653. @cindex Serial Wire Debug
  2654. SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
  2655. Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
  2656. (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
  2657. SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
  2658. Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
  2659. (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
  2660. SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
  2661. swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
  2662. driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
  2663. or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
  2664. the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
  2665. @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
  2666. Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
  2667. Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
  2668. expected to change.
  2669. @end deffn
  2670. @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
  2671. Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
  2672. Wire Control Register (WCR).
  2673. No parameters: displays current settings.
  2674. @end deffn
  2675. @subsection SPI Transport
  2676. @cindex SPI
  2677. @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
  2678. The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
  2679. which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
  2680. solution for flash programming.
  2681. @anchor{jtagspeed}
  2682. @section JTAG Speed
  2683. JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
  2684. It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
  2685. only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
  2686. Sometimes the JTAG speed is
  2687. changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
  2688. reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
  2689. Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
  2690. oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
  2691. power management software that may be active.
  2692. The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
  2693. follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
  2694. target event handler.
  2695. It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
  2696. @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
  2697. CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
  2698. sets up those clocks).
  2699. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  2700. When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
  2701. because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
  2702. in the target config file.
  2703. When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
  2704. such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
  2705. config file instead.
  2706. In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
  2707. to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
  2708. clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
  2709. @example
  2710. jtag_rclk 3000
  2711. $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
  2712. @end example
  2713. If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
  2714. JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
  2715. However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
  2716. may not be the fastest solution.
  2717. @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
  2718. instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
  2719. which support adaptive clocking.
  2720. @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
  2721. A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
  2722. JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
  2723. speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
  2724. than the speed specified.
  2725. Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
  2726. The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
  2727. and is normally less than that peak rate.
  2728. For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
  2729. Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
  2730. @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
  2731. If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
  2732. JTAG clocking after setup.
  2733. Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
  2734. If the interface device can not
  2735. support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
  2736. @end deffn
  2737. @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
  2738. @cindex adaptive clocking
  2739. @cindex RTCK
  2740. This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
  2741. If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
  2742. support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
  2743. @example
  2744. # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
  2745. jtag_rclk 3000
  2746. @end example
  2747. @end defun
  2748. @node Reset Configuration
  2749. @chapter Reset Configuration
  2750. @cindex Reset Configuration
  2751. Every system configuration may require a different reset
  2752. configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
  2753. Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
  2754. which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
  2755. JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
  2756. They can also interact with JTAG routers.
  2757. Please see the various board files for examples.
  2758. @quotation Note
  2759. To maintainers and integrators:
  2760. Reset configuration touches several things at once.
  2761. Normally the board configuration file
  2762. should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
  2763. everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
  2764. However, the target configuration file could also make note
  2765. of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
  2766. which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
  2767. And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
  2768. user configuration file will need to override parts of
  2769. the reset configuration provided by other files.
  2770. @end quotation
  2771. @section Types of Reset
  2772. There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
  2773. they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
  2774. That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
  2775. @itemize @bullet
  2776. @item
  2777. @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
  2778. resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
  2779. power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
  2780. with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
  2781. @item
  2782. @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
  2783. just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
  2784. Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
  2785. device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
  2786. @item
  2787. @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
  2788. commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
  2789. resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
  2790. or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
  2791. @item
  2792. @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
  2793. several other types of reset.
  2794. You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
  2795. while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
  2796. There may be individual module resets.
  2797. @end itemize
  2798. In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
  2799. the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
  2800. CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
  2801. Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
  2802. halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
  2803. This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
  2804. and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
  2805. board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
  2806. (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
  2807. @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
  2808. @section SRST and TRST Issues
  2809. Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
  2810. variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
  2811. common issues are:
  2812. @itemize @bullet
  2813. @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
  2814. SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
  2815. support such signals even if they are wired up.
  2816. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
  2817. when either of those signals is not connected.
  2818. When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
  2819. on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
  2820. Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
  2821. be triggered using with TMS signaling.
  2822. @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
  2823. adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
  2824. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
  2825. when those signals aren't properly independent.
  2826. @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
  2827. delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
  2828. the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
  2829. stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
  2830. requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
  2831. certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
  2832. hardware debouncing.
  2833. Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
  2834. commands to say when extra delays are needed.
  2835. @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
  2836. resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
  2837. signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
  2838. to use push/pull output drivers.
  2839. Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
  2840. signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
  2841. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
  2842. @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
  2843. @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
  2844. special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
  2845. issues (not limited to errata).
  2846. For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
  2847. the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
  2848. but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
  2849. Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
  2850. trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
  2851. Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
  2852. @end itemize
  2853. There can also be other issues.
  2854. Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
  2855. Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
  2856. SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
  2857. There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
  2858. their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
  2859. Agreement (NDA).
  2860. Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
  2861. the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
  2862. don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
  2863. In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
  2864. needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
  2865. @section Commands for Handling Resets
  2866. @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
  2867. Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
  2868. after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
  2869. allowing it to be deasserted.
  2870. @end deffn
  2871. @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
  2872. How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
  2873. nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
  2874. When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
  2875. probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
  2876. @end deffn
  2877. @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
  2878. Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
  2879. after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
  2880. allowing it to be deasserted.
  2881. @end deffn
  2882. @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
  2883. How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
  2884. nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
  2885. @end deffn
  2886. @anchor{reset_config}
  2887. @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
  2888. This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
  2889. of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
  2890. configuration scripts.
  2891. Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
  2892. the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
  2893. As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
  2894. describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
  2895. or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
  2896. from a particular combination of interface and board.
  2897. (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
  2898. with a board that only wires up SRST.)
  2899. The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
  2900. of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
  2901. @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
  2902. -- may be specified at a time.
  2903. If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
  2904. value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
  2905. For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
  2906. TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
  2907. it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
  2908. @itemize
  2909. @item
  2910. @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
  2911. For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
  2912. connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
  2913. Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
  2914. @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
  2915. @quotation Tip
  2916. If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
  2917. you must declare that so those signals can be used.
  2918. @end quotation
  2919. @item
  2920. The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
  2921. signal implementations.
  2922. The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
  2923. indicating everything behaves normally.
  2924. @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
  2925. test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
  2926. LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
  2927. the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
  2928. haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
  2929. @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
  2930. @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
  2931. @item
  2932. The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
  2933. JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
  2934. @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
  2935. indicates that asserting SRST gates the
  2936. JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
  2937. while SRST is asserted.
  2938. Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
  2939. can safely be issued while SRST is active.
  2940. @item
  2941. The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
  2942. SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
  2943. is required to use this option.
  2944. @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
  2945. indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
  2946. Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
  2947. be asserted before any target connection.
  2948. Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
  2949. This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
  2950. to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
  2951. @end itemize
  2952. The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
  2953. driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
  2954. JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
  2955. JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
  2956. relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
  2957. @itemize
  2958. @item
  2959. Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
  2960. are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
  2961. Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
  2962. never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
  2963. @item
  2964. Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
  2965. are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
  2966. Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
  2967. signal to be pulled low by various events including system
  2968. power-up and pressing a reset button.
  2969. @end itemize
  2970. @end deffn
  2971. @section Custom Reset Handling
  2972. @cindex events
  2973. OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
  2974. mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
  2975. The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
  2976. There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
  2977. Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
  2978. at particular points in the reset sequence.
  2979. @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
  2980. up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
  2981. For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
  2982. and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
  2983. want to reset everything at once.
  2984. After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
  2985. find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
  2986. For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
  2987. of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
  2988. the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
  2989. or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
  2990. needs special attention.
  2991. Experiment with lower level operations, such as
  2992. @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
  2993. and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
  2994. to find a sequence of operations that works.
  2995. @xref{JTAG Commands}.
  2996. When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
  2997. @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
  2998. (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
  2999. or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
  3000. You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
  3001. schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
  3002. @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
  3003. may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
  3004. thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
  3005. @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
  3006. This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
  3007. usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
  3008. By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
  3009. the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
  3010. The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
  3011. low level reset command (@option{halt},
  3012. @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
  3013. or potentially some other value.
  3014. The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
  3015. Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
  3016. operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
  3017. Operations here must not address individual TAPs
  3018. (or their associated targets)
  3019. until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
  3020. Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
  3021. they return.
  3022. This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
  3023. (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
  3024. @end deffn
  3025. @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
  3026. This validates the scan chain using just the four
  3027. standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
  3028. It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
  3029. Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
  3030. matches the TAPs it can observe.
  3031. Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
  3032. and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
  3033. TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
  3034. If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
  3035. issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
  3036. @end deffn
  3037. @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
  3038. This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
  3039. everything on the JTAG scan chain
  3040. (and anything else connected to SRST).
  3041. It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
  3042. @end deffn
  3043. @node TAP Declaration
  3044. @chapter TAP Declaration
  3045. @cindex TAP declaration
  3046. @cindex TAP configuration
  3047. @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
  3048. TAPs serve many roles, including:
  3049. @itemize @bullet
  3050. @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
  3051. @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
  3052. Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
  3053. @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
  3054. you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
  3055. start running that code.
  3056. @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
  3057. helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
  3058. and missing connections.
  3059. @end itemize
  3060. OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
  3061. Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
  3062. Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
  3063. which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
  3064. probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
  3065. @section Scan Chains
  3066. @cindex scan chain
  3067. TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
  3068. which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
  3069. They also need to be added to
  3070. OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
  3071. giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
  3072. Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
  3073. systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
  3074. More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
  3075. Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
  3076. several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
  3077. to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
  3078. You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
  3079. (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
  3080. command, presented in the next chapter.
  3081. That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
  3082. debugging targets.)
  3083. Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
  3084. @verbatim
  3085. TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
  3086. -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
  3087. 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
  3088. 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
  3089. 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
  3090. @end verbatim
  3091. OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
  3092. of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  3093. Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
  3094. because not all devices provide good support for that.
  3095. JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
  3096. chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
  3097. until they are told to do so.
  3098. The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
  3099. requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
  3100. @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
  3101. A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
  3102. @example
  3103. jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
  3104. @end example
  3105. Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
  3106. by a given chip.
  3107. Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
  3108. and so forth.
  3109. Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
  3110. That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
  3111. both inside a single chip and between them.
  3112. @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
  3113. For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
  3114. three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
  3115. document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
  3116. 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
  3117. @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
  3118. To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
  3119. includes commands something like this:
  3120. @example
  3121. jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
  3122. jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
  3123. jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
  3124. @end example
  3125. Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
  3126. instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
  3127. of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
  3128. @deffn Command {jtag names}
  3129. Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
  3130. Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
  3131. to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
  3132. @example
  3133. foreach t [jtag names] @{
  3134. puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
  3135. @}
  3136. @end example
  3137. @end deffn
  3138. @deffn Command {scan_chain}
  3139. Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
  3140. and their status.
  3141. The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
  3142. exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
  3143. but systems with a JTAG router can
  3144. enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
  3145. @end deffn
  3146. @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
  3147. @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
  3148. @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
  3149. @c (on entry to RESET state).
  3150. @section TAP Names
  3151. @cindex dotted name
  3152. When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
  3153. a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
  3154. name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
  3155. For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
  3156. @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
  3157. Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
  3158. refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
  3159. name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
  3160. The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
  3161. name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
  3162. and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
  3163. @section TAP Declaration Commands
  3164. @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
  3165. @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
  3166. Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
  3167. and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
  3168. The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
  3169. Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
  3170. defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
  3171. overridable.
  3172. @cindex TAP naming convention
  3173. The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
  3174. and should follow this convention:
  3175. @itemize @bullet
  3176. @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
  3177. @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
  3178. @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
  3179. @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
  3180. @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
  3181. @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
  3182. @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
  3183. on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
  3184. @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
  3185. with a single TAP;
  3186. @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
  3187. @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
  3188. For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
  3189. a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
  3190. @end itemize
  3191. Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
  3192. @itemize @bullet
  3193. @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
  3194. @*The length in bits of the
  3195. instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
  3196. @end itemize
  3197. A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
  3198. @itemize @bullet
  3199. @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
  3200. @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
  3201. linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
  3202. or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
  3203. You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
  3204. (the TAP is linked in).
  3205. @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
  3206. @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
  3207. @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
  3208. which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
  3209. These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
  3210. @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
  3211. ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
  3212. Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
  3213. values that were found but not included in the list.
  3214. Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
  3215. tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
  3216. are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
  3217. reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
  3218. hardware to find these values.
  3219. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  3220. @item @code{-ignore-version}
  3221. @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
  3222. option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
  3223. JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
  3224. to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
  3225. the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
  3226. @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
  3227. @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
  3228. on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
  3229. JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
  3230. By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
  3231. up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
  3232. additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
  3233. a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
  3234. @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
  3235. @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
  3236. to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
  3237. Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
  3238. there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
  3239. @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
  3240. @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
  3241. register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
  3242. This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
  3243. devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
  3244. @end itemize
  3245. @end deffn
  3246. @section Other TAP commands
  3247. @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
  3248. Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
  3249. @end deffn
  3250. @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
  3251. @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
  3252. At this writing this TAP attribute
  3253. mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
  3254. (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
  3255. mechanism for debugger targets.)
  3256. See the next section for information about the available events.
  3257. The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
  3258. a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
  3259. The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
  3260. @end deffn
  3261. @section TAP Events
  3262. @cindex events
  3263. @cindex TAP events
  3264. OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
  3265. The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
  3266. The other applies to debugger targets,
  3267. which are associated with certain TAPs.
  3268. The TAP events currently defined are:
  3269. @itemize @bullet
  3270. @item @b{post-reset}
  3271. @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
  3272. The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
  3273. Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
  3274. such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
  3275. exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
  3276. Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
  3277. @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
  3278. of any particular target.
  3279. @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
  3280. @item @b{setup}
  3281. @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
  3282. This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
  3283. @item @b{tap-disable}
  3284. @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
  3285. implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
  3286. by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
  3287. @item @b{tap-enable}
  3288. @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
  3289. implement @command{jtag tapenable}
  3290. by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
  3291. @end itemize
  3292. If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
  3293. specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
  3294. contents to be accurate), you might:
  3295. @example
  3296. jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
  3297. echo "JTAG Reset done"
  3298. ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
  3299. @}
  3300. @end example
  3301. @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
  3302. @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
  3303. @cindex JTAG Route Controller
  3304. @cindex jrc
  3305. In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
  3306. is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
  3307. Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
  3308. an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
  3309. Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
  3310. A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
  3311. told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
  3312. has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
  3313. be visible.
  3314. Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
  3315. ignores, such as:
  3316. @itemize
  3317. @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
  3318. @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
  3319. TAPs receive new instructions.
  3320. @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
  3321. power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
  3322. @end itemize
  3323. The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
  3324. as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
  3325. However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
  3326. does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
  3327. @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
  3328. @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
  3329. In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
  3330. shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
  3331. So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
  3332. a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
  3333. should define TAP event handlers using
  3334. code that looks something like this:
  3335. @example
  3336. jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
  3337. ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
  3338. @}
  3339. jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
  3340. ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
  3341. @}
  3342. @end example
  3343. Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
  3344. @example
  3345. jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
  3346. @end example
  3347. Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
  3348. uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
  3349. Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
  3350. at runtime, when it might have a different value.
  3351. @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
  3352. If necessary, disables the tap
  3353. by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
  3354. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3355. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3356. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3357. @end deffn
  3358. @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
  3359. If necessary, enables the tap
  3360. by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
  3361. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3362. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3363. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3364. @end deffn
  3365. @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
  3366. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3367. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3368. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3369. @quotation Note
  3370. Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
  3371. for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
  3372. @end quotation
  3373. @end deffn
  3374. @anchor{autoprobing}
  3375. @section Autoprobing
  3376. @cindex autoprobe
  3377. @cindex JTAG autoprobe
  3378. TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
  3379. after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
  3380. hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
  3381. Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
  3382. To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
  3383. @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
  3384. a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
  3385. To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
  3386. that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
  3387. with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
  3388. right when they come out of reset).
  3389. For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
  3390. @example
  3391. source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
  3392. reset_config trst_and_srst
  3393. jtag_rclk 8
  3394. @end example
  3395. When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
  3396. attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
  3397. @enumerate
  3398. @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
  3399. After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
  3400. each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
  3401. IDCODE or BYPASS register.
  3402. If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
  3403. and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
  3404. @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
  3405. Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
  3406. the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
  3407. that is discovered.
  3408. If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
  3409. register, it will report it.
  3410. Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
  3411. as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
  3412. @end enumerate
  3413. In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
  3414. a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
  3415. that's a bit more complex:
  3416. @example
  3417. clock speed 8 kHz
  3418. There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
  3419. AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
  3420. AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
  3421. AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
  3422. AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
  3423. AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
  3424. AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
  3425. no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
  3426. @end example
  3427. Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
  3428. config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
  3429. would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
  3430. with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
  3431. resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
  3432. and so forth.
  3433. @anchor{dapdeclaration}
  3434. @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
  3435. @cindex DAP declaration
  3436. Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
  3437. no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
  3438. explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
  3439. and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
  3440. instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
  3441. The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
  3442. @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
  3443. Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
  3444. @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
  3445. which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
  3446. There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
  3447. A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
  3448. @itemize @bullet
  3449. @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
  3450. @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
  3451. register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
  3452. This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
  3453. devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
  3454. @end itemize
  3455. @end deffn
  3456. @deffn Command {dap names}
  3457. This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
  3458. for TCL scripting.
  3459. @end deffn
  3460. @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
  3461. Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
  3462. defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
  3463. @end deffn
  3464. @deffn Command {dap init}
  3465. Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
  3466. during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
  3467. initialization, too.
  3468. @end deffn
  3469. The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
  3470. @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
  3471. Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
  3472. defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3473. @end deffn
  3474. @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
  3475. Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3476. @end deffn
  3477. @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
  3478. @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
  3479. Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
  3480. or set a new value @var{value}.
  3481. @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
  3482. @end deffn
  3483. @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
  3484. Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
  3485. @end deffn
  3486. @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
  3487. Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
  3488. value @var{value}.
  3489. In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
  3490. @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
  3491. In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
  3492. @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
  3493. background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
  3494. @end deffn
  3495. @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
  3496. Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
  3497. defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3498. @end deffn
  3499. @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
  3500. Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
  3501. memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
  3502. If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
  3503. @end deffn
  3504. @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
  3505. Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
  3506. At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
  3507. by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
  3508. and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
  3509. updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
  3510. the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
  3511. for details.
  3512. Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
  3513. The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
  3514. the pattern:
  3515. @example
  3516. kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
  3517. @end example
  3518. If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
  3519. where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
  3520. and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
  3521. DCache on Cortex-M7.
  3522. @example
  3523. set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
  3524. samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
  3525. @end example
  3526. Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
  3527. @example
  3528. set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
  3529. samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
  3530. @end example
  3531. @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
  3532. @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
  3533. @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
  3534. If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
  3535. example with a proper dap name:
  3536. @example
  3537. xxx.dap apcsw default
  3538. @end example
  3539. @end deffn
  3540. @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
  3541. Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
  3542. Disabled by default
  3543. @end deffn
  3544. @node CPU Configuration
  3545. @chapter CPU Configuration
  3546. @cindex GDB target
  3547. This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
  3548. You can also access these targets without GDB
  3549. (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
  3550. and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
  3551. through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
  3552. If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
  3553. We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
  3554. then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
  3555. @section Target List
  3556. @cindex target, current
  3557. @cindex target, list
  3558. All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
  3559. where each member has a name.
  3560. That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
  3561. You can display the list with the @command{targets}
  3562. (plural!) command.
  3563. This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
  3564. look like with more than one:
  3565. @verbatim
  3566. TargetName Type Endian TapName State
  3567. -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
  3568. 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
  3569. 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
  3570. @end verbatim
  3571. One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
  3572. is implicitly referenced by many commands.
  3573. It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
  3574. In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
  3575. space seen by that current target.
  3576. Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
  3577. and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
  3578. are examples; and there are many more.
  3579. Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
  3580. @deffn Command {target current}
  3581. Returns the name of the current target.
  3582. @end deffn
  3583. @deffn Command {target names}
  3584. Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
  3585. @example
  3586. foreach t [target names] @{
  3587. puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
  3588. @}
  3589. @end example
  3590. @end deffn
  3591. @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
  3592. @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
  3593. @deffn Command targets [name]
  3594. @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
  3595. command names are singular.}
  3596. With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
  3597. targets in a user friendly form.
  3598. With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
  3599. the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
  3600. only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
  3601. @end deffn
  3602. @section Target CPU Types
  3603. @cindex target type
  3604. @cindex CPU type
  3605. Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
  3606. the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
  3607. when calling @command{target create}.
  3608. The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
  3609. It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
  3610. what kind of debug support it integrates,
  3611. whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
  3612. what core-specific commands may be available
  3613. (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
  3614. and more.
  3615. It's easy to see what target types are supported,
  3616. since there's a command to list them.
  3617. @anchor{targettypes}
  3618. @deffn Command {target types}
  3619. Lists all supported target types.
  3620. At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
  3621. @itemize @bullet
  3622. @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
  3623. @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
  3624. @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
  3625. @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
  3626. @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
  3627. @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
  3628. @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
  3629. @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
  3630. (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
  3631. @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
  3632. @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
  3633. compact Thumb2 instruction set.
  3634. @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
  3635. @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
  3636. @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
  3637. (Support for this is still incomplete.)
  3638. @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
  3639. The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
  3640. @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
  3641. @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
  3642. @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
  3643. @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
  3644. @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
  3645. not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
  3646. @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
  3647. The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
  3648. @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
  3649. allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
  3650. @itemize @minus
  3651. @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
  3652. @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
  3653. @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
  3654. @end itemize
  3655. And two debug interfaces cores:
  3656. @itemize @minus
  3657. @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
  3658. @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
  3659. @end itemize
  3660. @end itemize
  3661. @end deffn
  3662. To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
  3663. this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
  3664. (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
  3665. The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
  3666. licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
  3667. Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
  3668. reflect design generations;
  3669. while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
  3670. reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
  3671. @anchor{targetconfiguration}
  3672. @section Target Configuration
  3673. Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
  3674. When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
  3675. which is used to set up the CPU support.
  3676. The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
  3677. right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
  3678. Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
  3679. use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
  3680. optional parts.
  3681. All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
  3682. command, created as part of target creation.
  3683. The two main things to configure after target creation are
  3684. a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
  3685. if the board setup code overrides them later;
  3686. and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
  3687. to be much more board-specific.
  3688. The key steps you use might look something like this
  3689. @example
  3690. dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
  3691. target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
  3692. MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
  3693. MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
  3694. MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
  3695. @end example
  3696. You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
  3697. on-chip SRAM.
  3698. Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
  3699. writes to target memory;
  3700. flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
  3701. GDB memory checksumming;
  3702. and more.
  3703. @quotation Warning
  3704. On more complex chips, the work area can become
  3705. inaccessible when application code
  3706. (such as an operating system)
  3707. enables or disables the MMU.
  3708. For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
  3709. address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
  3710. easy access to other addresses needed.
  3711. At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
  3712. @end quotation
  3713. It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
  3714. For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
  3715. common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
  3716. controllers.
  3717. That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
  3718. in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
  3719. external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
  3720. @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
  3721. This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
  3722. It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
  3723. command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
  3724. purposes including additional configuration.
  3725. @itemize @bullet
  3726. @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
  3727. By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
  3728. of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
  3729. using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
  3730. This name is also used to create the target object command,
  3731. referred to here as @command{$target_name},
  3732. and in other places the target needs to be identified.
  3733. @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
  3734. @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
  3735. @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
  3736. If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
  3737. You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
  3738. @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
  3739. @end itemize
  3740. @end deffn
  3741. @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
  3742. The options accepted by this command may also be
  3743. specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
  3744. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
  3745. using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
  3746. @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
  3747. For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
  3748. and changing its endianness.
  3749. @itemize @bullet
  3750. @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
  3751. used to access this target.
  3752. @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
  3753. this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
  3754. create and manage DAP instances.
  3755. @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
  3756. whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
  3757. @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
  3758. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  3759. Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
  3760. Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
  3761. two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
  3762. same event name assigns only one handler.
  3763. Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
  3764. before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
  3765. @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
  3766. whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
  3767. @emph{it is not backed up.}
  3768. When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
  3769. since performing a backup slows down operations.
  3770. For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
  3771. be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
  3772. @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
  3773. in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
  3774. or virtual address is being used.
  3775. @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
  3776. base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
  3777. @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
  3778. base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
  3779. @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
  3780. The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
  3781. @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
  3782. @anchor{rtostype}
  3783. @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
  3784. @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
  3785. @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
  3786. @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
  3787. @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
  3788. @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
  3789. scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
  3790. access the target for debugging.
  3791. @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
  3792. @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
  3793. Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
  3794. to separate access ports of the same DAP.
  3795. @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
  3796. to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
  3797. where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
  3798. @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
  3799. for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
  3800. @anchor{gdbportoverride}
  3801. @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
  3802. possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
  3803. Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
  3804. command @command{gdb_port}.
  3805. @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
  3806. @end itemize
  3807. @end deffn
  3808. @section Other $target_name Commands
  3809. @cindex object command
  3810. The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
  3811. and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
  3812. A good Tk example is a on screen button.
  3813. Once a button is created a button
  3814. has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
  3815. class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
  3816. configure it like this:
  3817. @example
  3818. # Create
  3819. button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
  3820. # Modify
  3821. .foobar configure -foreground blue
  3822. # Query
  3823. set x [.foobar cget -background]
  3824. # Report
  3825. puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
  3826. @end example
  3827. In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
  3828. button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
  3829. @example
  3830. str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
  3831. omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
  3832. @end example
  3833. The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
  3834. @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
  3835. @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
  3836. @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
  3837. @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
  3838. @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
  3839. Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
  3840. use these to deal with specific reset cases.
  3841. They are not otherwise documented here.
  3842. @end deffn
  3843. @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
  3844. @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
  3845. These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
  3846. The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
  3847. while @code{mem2array} reads them.
  3848. In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
  3849. the target side uses raw memory.
  3850. The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
  3851. bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
  3852. The script orientation comes from working with data
  3853. values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
  3854. @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
  3855. and neither store nor return those values.
  3856. @itemize
  3857. @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
  3858. @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
  3859. @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
  3860. @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
  3861. @end itemize
  3862. @end deffn
  3863. @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
  3864. Each configuration parameter accepted by
  3865. @command{$target_name configure}
  3866. can be individually queried, to return its current value.
  3867. The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
  3868. accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
  3869. There are a few special cases:
  3870. @itemize @bullet
  3871. @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
  3872. event named @var{event_name}.
  3873. This is a special case because setting a handler requires
  3874. two parameters.
  3875. @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
  3876. This is a special case because this is set using
  3877. @command{target create} and can't be changed
  3878. using @command{$target_name configure}.
  3879. @end itemize
  3880. For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
  3881. all the targets you might use something like this:
  3882. @example
  3883. foreach name [target names] @{
  3884. set y [$name cget -endian]
  3885. set z [$name cget -type]
  3886. puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
  3887. $x $name $y $z]
  3888. @}
  3889. @end example
  3890. @end deffn
  3891. @anchor{targetcurstate}
  3892. @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
  3893. Displays the current target state:
  3894. @code{debug-running},
  3895. @code{halted},
  3896. @code{reset},
  3897. @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
  3898. (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
  3899. @end deffn
  3900. @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
  3901. Displays a table listing all event handlers
  3902. currently associated with this target.
  3903. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  3904. @end deffn
  3905. @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
  3906. Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
  3907. (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
  3908. code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
  3909. @end deffn
  3910. @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
  3911. @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
  3912. @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
  3913. @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
  3914. Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
  3915. 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
  3916. 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
  3917. or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
  3918. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  3919. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  3920. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  3921. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  3922. If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
  3923. (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
  3924. see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
  3925. @end deffn
  3926. @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
  3927. @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
  3928. @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
  3929. @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
  3930. Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
  3931. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
  3932. at the specified address @var{addr}.
  3933. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  3934. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  3935. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  3936. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  3937. If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
  3938. @end deffn
  3939. @anchor{targetevents}
  3940. @section Target Events
  3941. @cindex target events
  3942. @cindex events
  3943. At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
  3944. For example:
  3945. @itemize @bullet
  3946. @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
  3947. @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
  3948. @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
  3949. Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
  3950. SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
  3951. @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
  3952. to set up system clocks or
  3953. to reconfigure the SDRAM?
  3954. How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
  3955. to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
  3956. @end itemize
  3957. All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
  3958. These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
  3959. @command{target create ... -event}.
  3960. The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
  3961. buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
  3962. and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
  3963. @example
  3964. proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
  3965. echo "Disabling watchdog..."
  3966. mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
  3967. @}
  3968. mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
  3969. mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
  3970. echo "Disabling watchdog..."
  3971. mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
  3972. @}
  3973. @end example
  3974. The following target events are defined:
  3975. @itemize @bullet
  3976. @item @b{debug-halted}
  3977. @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
  3978. @item @b{debug-resumed}
  3979. @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
  3980. @item @b{early-halted}
  3981. @* Occurs early in the halt process
  3982. @item @b{examine-start}
  3983. @* Before target examine is called.
  3984. @item @b{examine-end}
  3985. @* After target examine is called with no errors.
  3986. @item @b{gdb-attach}
  3987. @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
  3988. starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
  3989. @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
  3990. connect GDB to running target.
  3991. The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
  3992. Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
  3993. @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
  3994. Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
  3995. hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
  3996. is in RAM or read only memory.
  3997. Default is @code{halt}
  3998. @item @b{gdb-detach}
  3999. @* When GDB disconnects
  4000. @item @b{gdb-end}
  4001. @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
  4002. @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
  4003. @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
  4004. @code{reset init})
  4005. @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
  4006. @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
  4007. @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
  4008. @* Before GDB writes to the flash
  4009. @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
  4010. @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
  4011. @item @b{gdb-start}
  4012. @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
  4013. @item @b{halted}
  4014. @* The target has halted
  4015. @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
  4016. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4017. after @command{reset-start} was triggered
  4018. but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
  4019. or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
  4020. @item @b{reset-assert}
  4021. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4022. after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
  4023. When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
  4024. it instead of asserting SRST.
  4025. This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
  4026. don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
  4027. selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
  4028. @item @b{reset-assert-post}
  4029. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4030. after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
  4031. or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
  4032. @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
  4033. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4034. after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
  4035. @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
  4036. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4037. after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
  4038. and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
  4039. released on the scan chain.
  4040. @item @b{reset-end}
  4041. @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
  4042. @item @b{reset-init}
  4043. @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
  4044. This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
  4045. This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
  4046. you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
  4047. multiplexing, and so on.
  4048. (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
  4049. the target clocks are fully set up.)
  4050. @item @b{reset-start}
  4051. @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
  4052. before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
  4053. This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
  4054. or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
  4055. when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
  4056. @item @b{resume-start}
  4057. @* Before any target is resumed
  4058. @item @b{resume-end}
  4059. @* After all targets have resumed
  4060. @item @b{resumed}
  4061. @* Target has resumed
  4062. @item @b{trace-config}
  4063. @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
  4064. @end itemize
  4065. @node Flash Commands
  4066. @chapter Flash Commands
  4067. OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
  4068. the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
  4069. the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
  4070. This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
  4071. NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
  4072. while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
  4073. used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
  4074. However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
  4075. for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
  4076. Flash Steps:
  4077. @enumerate
  4078. @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
  4079. @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
  4080. passing parameters as needed by the driver.
  4081. @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
  4082. @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
  4083. via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
  4084. boot loader, operating system, or other data.
  4085. @item GDB Flashing
  4086. @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
  4087. bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
  4088. @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
  4089. @end enumerate
  4090. Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
  4091. This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
  4092. so that it can't boot.
  4093. JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
  4094. board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
  4095. @anchor{norconfiguration}
  4096. @section Flash Configuration Commands
  4097. @cindex flash configuration
  4098. @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
  4099. Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
  4100. for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
  4101. These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
  4102. In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
  4103. see the driver-specific documentation.
  4104. @itemize @bullet
  4105. @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
  4106. in other flash commands. A number is also available.
  4107. @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
  4108. associated with the flash bank being declared.
  4109. This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
  4110. the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
  4111. @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
  4112. @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
  4113. @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
  4114. For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
  4115. @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
  4116. ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
  4117. @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
  4118. chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
  4119. @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
  4120. commands to the flash controller.
  4121. @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
  4122. @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
  4123. additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
  4124. for more information.
  4125. @end itemize
  4126. @quotation Note
  4127. This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
  4128. Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
  4129. @end quotation
  4130. @end deffn
  4131. @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
  4132. @deffn Command {flash banks}
  4133. Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
  4134. declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
  4135. Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
  4136. the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
  4137. @end deffn
  4138. @deffn Command {flash list}
  4139. Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
  4140. declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
  4141. This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
  4142. @end deffn
  4143. @deffn Command {flash probe} num
  4144. Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
  4145. depends on the flash type.
  4146. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4147. Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
  4148. flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
  4149. but most don't bother.
  4150. @end deffn
  4151. @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
  4152. The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
  4153. begins.
  4154. @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
  4155. Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
  4156. until the programming session is finished.
  4157. If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
  4158. the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
  4159. The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
  4160. @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
  4161. @cindex flash erasing
  4162. @cindex flash reading
  4163. @cindex flash writing
  4164. @cindex flash programming
  4165. @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
  4166. One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
  4167. is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
  4168. This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
  4169. @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
  4170. @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
  4171. Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
  4172. before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
  4173. writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
  4174. for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
  4175. of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
  4176. @quotation Note
  4177. Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
  4178. chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
  4179. JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
  4180. back to a flash bank.
  4181. @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
  4182. @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
  4183. A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
  4184. and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
  4185. Avoid confusing the two command models.
  4186. @end quotation
  4187. Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
  4188. since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
  4189. For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
  4190. disabled first.
  4191. Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
  4192. and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
  4193. @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
  4194. @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
  4195. Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
  4196. up to and including @var{last}.
  4197. Sector numbering starts at 0.
  4198. Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
  4199. specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
  4200. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4201. @end deffn
  4202. @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
  4203. Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  4204. Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
  4205. flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
  4206. Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
  4207. end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
  4208. The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
  4209. the specified length must stay within that bank.
  4210. As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
  4211. the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
  4212. If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
  4213. before erase starts.
  4214. @end deffn
  4215. @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
  4216. @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
  4217. @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
  4218. Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
  4219. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
  4220. starting at @var{address} and continuing
  4221. for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
  4222. No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
  4223. before issuing this command.
  4224. Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
  4225. verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
  4226. The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
  4227. each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
  4228. @end deffn
  4229. @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
  4230. @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
  4231. Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
  4232. starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
  4233. is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
  4234. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4235. @end deffn
  4236. @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
  4237. Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
  4238. and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
  4239. omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
  4240. read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
  4241. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4242. @end deffn
  4243. @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
  4244. Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
  4245. flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
  4246. start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
  4247. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4248. @end deffn
  4249. @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
  4250. Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
  4251. Only loadable sections from the image are written.
  4252. A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
  4253. to the base address for each section in the image.
  4254. The file [@var{type}] can be specified
  4255. explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
  4256. @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
  4257. @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
  4258. The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
  4259. if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
  4260. provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
  4261. program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
  4262. each image section.
  4263. @quotation Warning
  4264. Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
  4265. data you want to preserve.
  4266. Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
  4267. sections might be erased with no notice.
  4268. @itemize
  4269. @item
  4270. When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
  4271. sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
  4272. also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
  4273. @item
  4274. Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
  4275. For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
  4276. one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
  4277. erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
  4278. @end itemize
  4279. Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
  4280. it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
  4281. @end quotation
  4282. @end deffn
  4283. @section Other Flash commands
  4284. @cindex flash protection
  4285. @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
  4286. Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
  4287. and display that status.
  4288. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4289. @end deffn
  4290. @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
  4291. Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
  4292. and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
  4293. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4294. This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
  4295. and possibly stale information.
  4296. @end deffn
  4297. @anchor{flashprotect}
  4298. @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
  4299. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
  4300. in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
  4301. and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
  4302. Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
  4303. specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
  4304. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4305. The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
  4306. Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
  4307. See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
  4308. @end deffn
  4309. @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
  4310. Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
  4311. normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
  4312. command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
  4313. @end deffn
  4314. @anchor{program}
  4315. @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
  4316. This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
  4317. programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
  4318. @xref{Flash Programming}.
  4319. @end deffn
  4320. @anchor{flashdriverlist}
  4321. @section Flash Driver List
  4322. As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
  4323. and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
  4324. Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
  4325. @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
  4326. This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
  4327. address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
  4328. The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
  4329. @itemize
  4330. @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
  4331. @end itemize
  4332. So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
  4333. the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
  4334. the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
  4335. @example
  4336. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4337. flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
  4338. $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
  4339. flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
  4340. $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
  4341. @end example
  4342. @end deffn
  4343. @subsection External Flash
  4344. @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
  4345. @cindex Common Flash Interface
  4346. @cindex CFI
  4347. The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
  4348. external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
  4349. specific external chip select on the CPU.
  4350. Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
  4351. Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
  4352. configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
  4353. configure a bus and its timings), or
  4354. perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
  4355. on the flash chip.
  4356. The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
  4357. speed up operation.
  4358. The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
  4359. @itemize
  4360. @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
  4361. like AM29LV010 and similar types.
  4362. @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
  4363. @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
  4364. @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
  4365. swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
  4366. @end itemize
  4367. To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
  4368. wide on a sixteen bit bus:
  4369. @example
  4370. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
  4371. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
  4372. @end example
  4373. To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
  4374. built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
  4375. to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
  4376. @example
  4377. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
  4378. @end example
  4379. @c "cfi part_id" disabled
  4380. @end deffn
  4381. @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
  4382. @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
  4383. @cindex SPI
  4384. @cindex jtagspi
  4385. @cindex bscan_spi
  4386. Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
  4387. SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
  4388. is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
  4389. exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
  4390. accessed through JTAG.
  4391. Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
  4392. a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
  4393. the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
  4394. a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
  4395. @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
  4396. @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
  4397. This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
  4398. tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
  4399. "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
  4400. mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
  4401. will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
  4402. @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
  4403. functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
  4404. @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
  4405. @itemize
  4406. @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
  4407. For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
  4408. @var{USER1} instruction.
  4409. @end itemize
  4410. @example
  4411. target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
  4412. set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
  4413. flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
  4414. $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
  4415. @end example
  4416. @end deffn
  4417. @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
  4418. @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
  4419. @cindex xcf
  4420. Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
  4421. It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
  4422. only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
  4423. They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
  4424. additional @var{xcf} driver command:
  4425. @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
  4426. command accepts additional parameters:
  4427. @itemize
  4428. @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
  4429. @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
  4430. @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
  4431. @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
  4432. in master mode.
  4433. @end itemize
  4434. @example
  4435. xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
  4436. @end example
  4437. All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
  4438. in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
  4439. CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
  4440. every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
  4441. dedicated sector.
  4442. @end deffn
  4443. @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
  4444. Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
  4445. button.
  4446. @example
  4447. xcf configure 0
  4448. @end example
  4449. @end deffn
  4450. Additional driver notes:
  4451. @itemize
  4452. @item Only single revision supported.
  4453. @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
  4454. only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
  4455. (Intel hex) file types supported.
  4456. @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
  4457. @end itemize
  4458. @end deffn
  4459. @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
  4460. @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
  4461. @cindex SPIFI
  4462. @cindex lpcspifi
  4463. NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
  4464. Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
  4465. memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
  4466. The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
  4467. program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
  4468. Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
  4469. to be configured on the target device; more than this will
  4470. significantly reduce flash programming times.
  4471. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
  4472. other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
  4473. are configured by the driver.
  4474. @example
  4475. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4476. @end example
  4477. @end deffn
  4478. @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
  4479. @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
  4480. @cindex SMI
  4481. @cindex stmsmi
  4482. Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
  4483. SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
  4484. ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
  4485. SPI flash devices.
  4486. Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
  4487. flash devices can be connected.
  4488. SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
  4489. space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
  4490. CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
  4491. Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
  4492. the flash content.
  4493. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
  4494. to identify the memory bank.
  4495. All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
  4496. flash size, are detected automatically.
  4497. @example
  4498. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4499. @end example
  4500. @end deffn
  4501. @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
  4502. This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
  4503. Microcontroller platform.
  4504. The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
  4505. hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
  4506. @example
  4507. flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
  4508. @end example
  4509. @end deffn
  4510. @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
  4511. @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
  4512. @cindex ath79
  4513. Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
  4514. chip selects.
  4515. On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
  4516. directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
  4517. and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
  4518. Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
  4519. the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
  4520. 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
  4521. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
  4522. to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
  4523. is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
  4524. to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
  4525. address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
  4526. chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
  4527. that does not overlap with real memory regions.
  4528. Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
  4529. An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
  4530. with the default CS0.
  4531. CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
  4532. since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
  4533. CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
  4534. @example
  4535. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4536. # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
  4537. # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
  4538. # banks.
  4539. flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
  4540. flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
  4541. flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
  4542. @end example
  4543. @end deffn
  4544. @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
  4545. @cindex Freedom E SPI
  4546. @cindex fespi
  4547. SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
  4548. @example
  4549. flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4550. @end example
  4551. @end deffn
  4552. @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
  4553. @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
  4554. The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
  4555. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  4556. The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
  4557. The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
  4558. since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
  4559. @example
  4560. flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4561. @end example
  4562. @end deffn
  4563. @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
  4564. @cindex ambiqmicro
  4565. @cindex apollo
  4566. All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
  4567. Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  4568. The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
  4569. with the target using SWD.
  4570. The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
  4571. the device class of the MCU.
  4572. The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
  4573. to set up the flash banks.
  4574. If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
  4575. sizes of an Apollo chip.
  4576. All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
  4577. In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
  4578. and the second bank starts after the first.
  4579. @example
  4580. # Flash bank 0
  4581. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4582. # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
  4583. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
  4584. $_TARGETNAME
  4585. @end example
  4586. Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
  4587. This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
  4588. are available to the user.
  4589. The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
  4590. @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
  4591. Erase entire bank.
  4592. @end deffn
  4593. @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
  4594. Erase device pages.
  4595. @end deffn
  4596. @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
  4597. Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
  4598. The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
  4599. Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
  4600. the flash.
  4601. @end deffn
  4602. @end deffn
  4603. @anchor{at91samd}
  4604. @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
  4605. @cindex at91samd
  4606. All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
  4607. families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
  4608. Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
  4609. The devices have one flash bank:
  4610. @example
  4611. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  4612. @end example
  4613. @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
  4614. Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
  4615. used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
  4616. processor to be halted.
  4617. @end deffn
  4618. @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
  4619. Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
  4620. to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
  4621. erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
  4622. time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
  4623. therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
  4624. @example
  4625. at91samd set-security enable
  4626. @end example
  4627. @end deffn
  4628. @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
  4629. Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
  4630. of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
  4631. must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
  4632. written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
  4633. requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
  4634. the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
  4635. in order to disable this feature.
  4636. @example
  4637. at91samd eeprom
  4638. at91samd eeprom 1024
  4639. @end example
  4640. @end deffn
  4641. @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
  4642. Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
  4643. Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
  4644. must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
  4645. to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
  4646. MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
  4647. @example
  4648. at91samd bootloader
  4649. at91samd bootloader 16384
  4650. @end example
  4651. @end deffn
  4652. @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
  4653. This command releases internal reset held by DSU
  4654. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  4655. Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
  4656. @end deffn
  4657. @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
  4658. Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
  4659. 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
  4660. data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
  4661. arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
  4662. is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
  4663. Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
  4664. reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
  4665. @example
  4666. # Read user row
  4667. >at91samd nvmuserrow
  4668. NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
  4669. # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
  4670. >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
  4671. # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
  4672. >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
  4673. @end example
  4674. @end deffn
  4675. @end deffn
  4676. @anchor{at91sam3}
  4677. @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
  4678. @cindex at91sam3
  4679. All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
  4680. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
  4681. currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
  4682. that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
  4683. AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
  4684. the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
  4685. readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
  4686. chips are confirmed.}
  4687. The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
  4688. have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
  4689. the following fixed locations:
  4690. @example
  4691. # Flash bank 0 - all chips
  4692. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  4693. # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
  4694. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  4695. @end example
  4696. Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
  4697. Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
  4698. to the @command{flash bank} command:
  4699. @itemize
  4700. @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
  4701. @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
  4702. @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
  4703. @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
  4704. @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
  4705. @end itemize
  4706. The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
  4707. @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
  4708. @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
  4709. @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
  4710. @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
  4711. With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
  4712. shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
  4713. With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
  4714. With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
  4715. modifies that GPNVM bit.
  4716. @end deffn
  4717. @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
  4718. This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
  4719. chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
  4720. Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
  4721. document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
  4722. various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
  4723. believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
  4724. be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
  4725. @end deffn
  4726. @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
  4727. This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
  4728. @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
  4729. @end deffn
  4730. @end deffn
  4731. @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
  4732. @cindex at91sam4
  4733. All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
  4734. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  4735. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  4736. @end deffn
  4737. @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
  4738. @cindex at91sam4l
  4739. All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
  4740. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  4741. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  4742. The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
  4743. @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
  4744. This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
  4745. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  4746. Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
  4747. @end deffn
  4748. @end deffn
  4749. @anchor{atsame5}
  4750. @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
  4751. @cindex atsame5
  4752. All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
  4753. families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
  4754. and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  4755. The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
  4756. This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
  4757. Bank swapping is not supported yet.
  4758. @example
  4759. flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  4760. @end example
  4761. @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
  4762. Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
  4763. Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
  4764. must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
  4765. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
  4766. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
  4767. @example
  4768. atsame5 bootloader
  4769. atsame5 bootloader 16384
  4770. @end example
  4771. @end deffn
  4772. @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
  4773. Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
  4774. used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
  4775. processor to be halted.
  4776. @end deffn
  4777. @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
  4778. This command releases internal reset held by DSU
  4779. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  4780. Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
  4781. @end deffn
  4782. @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
  4783. Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
  4784. 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
  4785. Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
  4786. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
  4787. is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
  4788. (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
  4789. The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
  4790. @example
  4791. # Read
  4792. >atsame5 userpage
  4793. USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
  4794. # Write
  4795. >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
  4796. # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
  4797. # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
  4798. >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
  4799. @end example
  4800. @end deffn
  4801. @end deffn
  4802. @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
  4803. @cindex atsamv
  4804. All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
  4805. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
  4806. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  4807. @end deffn
  4808. @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
  4809. All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
  4810. internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
  4811. recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
  4812. register, and autoconfigures itself.
  4813. @example
  4814. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4815. @end example
  4816. For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
  4817. provide additional parameters in the following order:
  4818. @itemize
  4819. @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
  4820. @item @var{banks}
  4821. @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
  4822. @item @var{pages_per_sector}
  4823. @item @var{pages_size}
  4824. @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
  4825. @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
  4826. optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
  4827. @end itemize
  4828. It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
  4829. except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
  4830. will be autoconfigured.
  4831. Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
  4832. The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
  4833. basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
  4834. However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
  4835. plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
  4836. @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
  4837. @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
  4838. Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
  4839. bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
  4840. used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
  4841. are not truly general purpose).
  4842. @quotation Note
  4843. This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
  4844. the appropriate at91sam7 target.
  4845. @end quotation
  4846. @end deffn
  4847. @end deffn
  4848. @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
  4849. The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
  4850. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
  4851. @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
  4852. @end deffn
  4853. @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
  4854. STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
  4855. The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
  4856. the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
  4857. @example
  4858. flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4859. @end example
  4860. Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
  4861. each single sector one by one.
  4862. @example
  4863. flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
  4864. @end example
  4865. @example
  4866. flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
  4867. @end example
  4868. Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
  4869. @end deffn
  4870. @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
  4871. All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
  4872. Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
  4873. CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
  4874. specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
  4875. starts at address 0.
  4876. @example
  4877. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4878. @end example
  4879. @end deffn
  4880. @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
  4881. The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
  4882. Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
  4883. supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
  4884. programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
  4885. the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
  4886. documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
  4887. and programming the serial flash.
  4888. @example
  4889. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4890. @end example
  4891. @end deffn
  4892. @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
  4893. All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
  4894. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
  4895. a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
  4896. autoconfigures itself.
  4897. @example
  4898. flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4899. @end example
  4900. A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
  4901. debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
  4902. this via the following command:
  4903. @example
  4904. efm32 debuglock num
  4905. @end example
  4906. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4907. Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
  4908. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
  4909. supported.}
  4910. @end deffn
  4911. @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
  4912. Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
  4913. via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
  4914. configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
  4915. configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
  4916. frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
  4917. @example
  4918. flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
  4919. $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
  4920. @end example
  4921. @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
  4922. Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
  4923. @end deffn
  4924. @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
  4925. Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
  4926. is an uncommon operation.}
  4927. @end deffn
  4928. @end deffn
  4929. @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
  4930. All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
  4931. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  4932. The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
  4933. correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
  4934. @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
  4935. @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
  4936. @example
  4937. flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4938. @end example
  4939. @end deffn
  4940. @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
  4941. All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
  4942. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
  4943. The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
  4944. correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
  4945. @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
  4946. @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
  4947. with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
  4948. characters) ignored.
  4949. @example
  4950. flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
  4951. $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
  4952. flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
  4953. $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
  4954. @end example
  4955. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
  4956. nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
  4957. @end deffn
  4958. @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
  4959. @cindex kinetis
  4960. Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
  4961. from NXP (former Freescale) include
  4962. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
  4963. recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
  4964. identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  4965. Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
  4966. The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
  4967. @itemize
  4968. @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
  4969. @end itemize
  4970. @example
  4971. flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4972. @end example
  4973. @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
  4974. Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
  4975. based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
  4976. Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
  4977. @end deffn
  4978. @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
  4979. Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
  4980. @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
  4981. set by 'flash protect' command.
  4982. This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
  4983. writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
  4984. @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
  4985. Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
  4986. with the rest of a flash image.
  4987. @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
  4988. @end deffn
  4989. @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
  4990. Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
  4991. Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
  4992. @end deffn
  4993. @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
  4994. Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
  4995. @end deffn
  4996. @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
  4997. Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
  4998. loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
  4999. @end deffn
  5000. @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
  5001. Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
  5002. back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
  5003. to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
  5004. command completes.
  5005. @end deffn
  5006. @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
  5007. For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
  5008. Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
  5009. sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
  5010. of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
  5011. For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
  5012. Program Partition command.
  5013. Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
  5014. Reset the device after partition setting.
  5015. Show partition size:
  5016. @example
  5017. kinetis nvm_partition info
  5018. @end example
  5019. Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
  5020. of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
  5021. @example
  5022. kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
  5023. @end example
  5024. Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
  5025. of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
  5026. @example
  5027. kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
  5028. @end example
  5029. @end deffn
  5030. @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
  5031. Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
  5032. RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
  5033. @end deffn
  5034. @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
  5035. For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
  5036. Command disables watchdog timer.
  5037. @end deffn
  5038. @end deffn
  5039. @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
  5040. @cindex kinetis_ke
  5041. KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
  5042. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
  5043. the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
  5044. autoconfigures itself.
  5045. Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
  5046. @example
  5047. flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5048. @end example
  5049. @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
  5050. Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
  5051. @end deffn
  5052. @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
  5053. Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
  5054. This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
  5055. Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
  5056. It does not require the processor to be halted.
  5057. @end deffn
  5058. @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
  5059. Command disables watchdog timer.
  5060. @end deffn
  5061. @end deffn
  5062. @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
  5063. This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
  5064. LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
  5065. the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
  5066. LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
  5067. @quotation Note
  5068. There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
  5069. driver:
  5070. The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
  5071. The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
  5072. @end quotation
  5073. The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
  5074. which must appear in the following order:
  5075. @itemize
  5076. @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
  5077. @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
  5078. @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
  5079. @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
  5080. @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
  5081. LPC43x[2357])
  5082. @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
  5083. @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
  5084. @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
  5085. @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
  5086. @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
  5087. or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
  5088. LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
  5089. @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
  5090. at which the core is running
  5091. @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
  5092. telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
  5093. @quotation Note
  5094. If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
  5095. table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
  5096. However, if you do provide it,
  5097. with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
  5098. @end quotation
  5099. @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
  5100. ROM IAP entry point.
  5101. @end itemize
  5102. LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5103. @example
  5104. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
  5105. lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
  5106. @end example
  5107. @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
  5108. Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
  5109. the specified flash @var{bank}.
  5110. @end deffn
  5111. @end deffn
  5112. @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
  5113. The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
  5114. support from its lpc2000 siblings.
  5115. The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
  5116. the programming clock rate in Hz.
  5117. LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5118. @example
  5119. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
  5120. @end example
  5121. @end deffn
  5122. @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
  5123. This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
  5124. from NXP.
  5125. The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
  5126. @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
  5127. sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
  5128. The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
  5129. (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
  5130. will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
  5131. @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
  5132. you start the PLL.
  5133. The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
  5134. The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
  5135. It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
  5136. handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
  5137. Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
  5138. sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
  5139. What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
  5140. actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
  5141. sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
  5142. mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
  5143. and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
  5144. Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
  5145. @example
  5146. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
  5147. @end example
  5148. Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
  5149. the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
  5150. @code{flash banks} command.
  5151. @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
  5152. Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
  5153. content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
  5154. very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
  5155. a known signature.
  5156. Example:
  5157. @example
  5158. lpc2900 signature 0
  5159. signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
  5160. @end example
  5161. @end deffn
  5162. @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
  5163. Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
  5164. saves it to a file in binary format.
  5165. Example:
  5166. @example
  5167. lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
  5168. @end example
  5169. @end deffn
  5170. The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
  5171. erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
  5172. commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
  5173. command:
  5174. @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
  5175. You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
  5176. @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
  5177. @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
  5178. The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
  5179. Example:
  5180. @example
  5181. lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
  5182. Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
  5183. @end example
  5184. @end deffn
  5185. @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
  5186. Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
  5187. sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
  5188. for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
  5189. @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
  5190. contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
  5191. 912 bytes.
  5192. @quotation Attention
  5193. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5194. @end quotation
  5195. Example:
  5196. @example
  5197. lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
  5198. @end example
  5199. @end deffn
  5200. @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
  5201. Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
  5202. further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
  5203. after the next power cycle.
  5204. @quotation Attention
  5205. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5206. @end quotation
  5207. Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
  5208. Example:
  5209. @example
  5210. lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
  5211. flash info 0
  5212. #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
  5213. # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
  5214. # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
  5215. # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
  5216. @end example
  5217. @end deffn
  5218. @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
  5219. Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
  5220. effective after the next power cycle.
  5221. @quotation Attention
  5222. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5223. @end quotation
  5224. Examples:
  5225. @example
  5226. lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
  5227. @end example
  5228. @end deffn
  5229. @end deffn
  5230. @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
  5231. This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
  5232. based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
  5233. read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
  5234. @example
  5235. flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
  5236. 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
  5237. @end example
  5238. @itemize @bullet
  5239. @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
  5240. @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
  5241. @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
  5242. @end itemize
  5243. Example usage:
  5244. @example
  5245. if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
  5246. flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
  5247. 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
  5248. @} else @{
  5249. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
  5250. 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
  5251. @}
  5252. @end example
  5253. @end deffn
  5254. @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
  5255. All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
  5256. Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
  5257. recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
  5258. Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
  5259. region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
  5260. @example
  5261. flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5262. @end example
  5263. @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
  5264. Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
  5265. only the main program flash.
  5266. On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
  5267. main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
  5268. flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
  5269. @end deffn
  5270. @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
  5271. On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
  5272. region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
  5273. Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
  5274. To erase and program the BSL:
  5275. @example
  5276. msp432 bsl unlock
  5277. flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
  5278. flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
  5279. msp432 bsl lock
  5280. @end example
  5281. @end deffn
  5282. @end deffn
  5283. @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
  5284. This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
  5285. based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
  5286. Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
  5287. Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
  5288. but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
  5289. Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
  5290. There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
  5291. also have division into regions: main and info.
  5292. Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
  5293. Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
  5294. @example
  5295. flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5296. @end example
  5297. Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
  5298. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
  5299. Read byte from main or info userflash region.
  5300. @end deffn
  5301. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
  5302. Write byte to main or info userflash region.
  5303. @end deffn
  5304. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
  5305. Erase all userflash including info region.
  5306. @end deffn
  5307. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
  5308. Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
  5309. @end deffn
  5310. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
  5311. Check sectors protect.
  5312. @end deffn
  5313. @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
  5314. Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
  5315. @end deffn
  5316. @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
  5317. Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
  5318. @end deffn
  5319. @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
  5320. Configure external memory interface for boot.
  5321. @end deffn
  5322. @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
  5323. Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
  5324. @end deffn
  5325. @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
  5326. Show information about flash driver.
  5327. @end deffn
  5328. @end deffn
  5329. @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
  5330. All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
  5331. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
  5332. Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
  5333. internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
  5334. @example
  5335. flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5336. @end example
  5337. Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
  5338. @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
  5339. Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
  5340. configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
  5341. works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
  5342. code.
  5343. @end deffn
  5344. @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
  5345. Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
  5346. @end deffn
  5347. @end deffn
  5348. @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
  5349. This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
  5350. protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
  5351. It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
  5352. over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
  5353. loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
  5354. available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
  5355. @example
  5356. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5357. @end example
  5358. @end deffn
  5359. @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
  5360. The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
  5361. and integrate flash memory.
  5362. @example
  5363. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5364. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5365. @end example
  5366. @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
  5367. @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
  5368. @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
  5369. @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
  5370. Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
  5371. @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
  5372. Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
  5373. in the specified chip @var{bank}.
  5374. @end deffn
  5375. @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
  5376. Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
  5377. This will remove any Code Protection.
  5378. @end deffn
  5379. @end deffn
  5380. @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
  5381. All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
  5382. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
  5383. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5384. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5385. Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
  5386. System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
  5387. @example
  5388. flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5389. @end example
  5390. psoc4-specific commands
  5391. @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
  5392. Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
  5393. If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
  5394. Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
  5395. If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
  5396. system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
  5397. This mode is suitable for gdb load.
  5398. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5399. @end deffn
  5400. @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
  5401. Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
  5402. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5403. @end deffn
  5404. @end deffn
  5405. @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
  5406. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5407. include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5408. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
  5409. apart from the base address.
  5410. @example
  5411. flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5412. @end example
  5413. @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
  5414. @quotation Attention
  5415. If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
  5416. the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
  5417. then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
  5418. Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
  5419. @end quotation
  5420. Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
  5421. @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
  5422. Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
  5423. and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
  5424. @end deffn
  5425. @end deffn
  5426. @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
  5427. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5428. include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5429. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
  5430. apart from the base address.
  5431. @example
  5432. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5433. @end example
  5434. @end deffn
  5435. @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
  5436. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5437. include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5438. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
  5439. @example
  5440. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5441. @end example
  5442. PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
  5443. @itemize
  5444. @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
  5445. @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
  5446. @end itemize
  5447. @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
  5448. The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
  5449. @quotation Attention
  5450. Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
  5451. after successful write.
  5452. @end quotation
  5453. @end deffn
  5454. @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
  5455. Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
  5456. PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
  5457. the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
  5458. Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
  5459. @itemize @bullet
  5460. @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
  5461. Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
  5462. 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
  5463. @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
  5464. (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
  5465. row size: 512 bytes.
  5466. @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
  5467. service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
  5468. be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
  5469. operation will erase row automatically.
  5470. @end itemize
  5471. All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
  5472. automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
  5473. PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
  5474. @example
  5475. flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5476. flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5477. flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5478. flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5479. flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5480. flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5481. flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5482. flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5483. flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5484. flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5485. flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5486. flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5487. @end example
  5488. psoc6-specific commands
  5489. @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
  5490. Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
  5491. When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
  5492. and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
  5493. reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
  5494. instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
  5495. @end deffn
  5496. @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
  5497. Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
  5498. by @command{flash banks}.
  5499. Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
  5500. @end deffn
  5501. @end deffn
  5502. @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
  5503. All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
  5504. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
  5505. and SWD interface.
  5506. The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
  5507. If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
  5508. @example
  5509. flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5510. @end example
  5511. There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
  5512. @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
  5513. Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
  5514. And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
  5515. @end deffn
  5516. @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
  5517. Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
  5518. @end deffn
  5519. @end deffn
  5520. @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
  5521. All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
  5522. families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
  5523. automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
  5524. identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5525. @example
  5526. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5527. @end example
  5528. @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
  5529. Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
  5530. the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
  5531. default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
  5532. protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
  5533. disabled.
  5534. Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
  5535. must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
  5536. @quotation Warning
  5537. if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
  5538. applied to all of them.
  5539. @end quotation
  5540. @end deffn
  5541. @end deffn
  5542. @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
  5543. All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
  5544. from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
  5545. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5546. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5547. @example
  5548. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5549. @end example
  5550. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5551. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5552. the flash driver.
  5553. @example
  5554. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5555. @end example
  5556. If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
  5557. as per the following example.
  5558. @example
  5559. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5560. @end example
  5561. Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
  5562. @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
  5563. Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
  5564. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5565. @end deffn
  5566. @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
  5567. Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
  5568. a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
  5569. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5570. @end deffn
  5571. @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
  5572. Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
  5573. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5574. @end deffn
  5575. @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
  5576. Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
  5577. or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
  5578. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5579. @end deffn
  5580. @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
  5581. Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
  5582. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5583. The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
  5584. @end deffn
  5585. @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
  5586. Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
  5587. by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
  5588. without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
  5589. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5590. @end deffn
  5591. @end deffn
  5592. @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
  5593. All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  5594. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
  5595. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5596. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5597. @example
  5598. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5599. @end example
  5600. If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
  5601. as per the following example.
  5602. @example
  5603. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5604. @end example
  5605. @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
  5606. Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
  5607. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5608. @end deffn
  5609. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5610. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5611. the flash driver.
  5612. @example
  5613. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5614. @end example
  5615. Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
  5616. @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
  5617. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  5618. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5619. @end deffn
  5620. @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
  5621. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  5622. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5623. @end deffn
  5624. @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
  5625. Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
  5626. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5627. @end deffn
  5628. @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
  5629. Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
  5630. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5631. @end deffn
  5632. @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
  5633. Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
  5634. Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
  5635. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
  5636. 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
  5637. @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
  5638. @end deffn
  5639. @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
  5640. Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
  5641. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
  5642. @end deffn
  5643. @end deffn
  5644. @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
  5645. All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  5646. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
  5647. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5648. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5649. @example
  5650. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5651. @end example
  5652. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5653. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5654. the flash driver.
  5655. @example
  5656. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5657. @end example
  5658. Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
  5659. @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
  5660. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  5661. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5662. @end deffn
  5663. @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
  5664. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  5665. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5666. @end deffn
  5667. @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
  5668. Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
  5669. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5670. @end deffn
  5671. @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
  5672. Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
  5673. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  5674. is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
  5675. For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
  5676. Example usage:
  5677. @example
  5678. # read OPTSR_CUR
  5679. stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
  5680. # read WPSN_CUR1R
  5681. stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
  5682. # read WPSN_CUR2R
  5683. stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
  5684. @end example
  5685. @end deffn
  5686. @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
  5687. Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
  5688. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  5689. is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
  5690. and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
  5691. will be touched).
  5692. Example usage:
  5693. @example
  5694. # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
  5695. stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
  5696. @end example
  5697. @end deffn
  5698. @end deffn
  5699. @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
  5700. All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  5701. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
  5702. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5703. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5704. @example
  5705. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5706. @end example
  5707. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5708. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5709. the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
  5710. driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
  5711. second bank.
  5712. @example
  5713. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5714. @end example
  5715. Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
  5716. @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
  5717. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  5718. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5719. @end deffn
  5720. @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
  5721. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  5722. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5723. @end deffn
  5724. @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
  5725. Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
  5726. data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
  5727. Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
  5728. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5729. @end deffn
  5730. @end deffn
  5731. @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
  5732. All members of the STM32L4 and STM32WB microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  5733. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
  5734. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5735. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5736. @example
  5737. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5738. @end example
  5739. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5740. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5741. the flash driver.
  5742. @example
  5743. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5744. @end example
  5745. Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
  5746. @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
  5747. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  5748. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5749. @end deffn
  5750. @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
  5751. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  5752. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5753. @end deffn
  5754. @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
  5755. Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
  5756. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5757. @end deffn
  5758. @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
  5759. Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
  5760. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  5761. is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
  5762. For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
  5763. @example
  5764. stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
  5765. # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
  5766. # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
  5767. # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
  5768. @end example
  5769. The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
  5770. option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
  5771. @end deffn
  5772. @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
  5773. Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
  5774. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  5775. is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
  5776. to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
  5777. For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
  5778. @example
  5779. stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
  5780. @end example
  5781. The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
  5782. Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
  5783. This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
  5784. @end deffn
  5785. @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
  5786. Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
  5787. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5788. @end deffn
  5789. @end deffn
  5790. @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
  5791. All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
  5792. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  5793. The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
  5794. which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
  5795. @example
  5796. flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
  5797. 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
  5798. @end example
  5799. @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
  5800. Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
  5801. for the specified flash bank.
  5802. @end deffn
  5803. @end deffn
  5804. @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
  5805. Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
  5806. include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
  5807. The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
  5808. the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
  5809. @example
  5810. flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5811. str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
  5812. @end example
  5813. @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
  5814. Configures the str9 flash controller.
  5815. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5816. @itemize @bullet
  5817. @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
  5818. @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
  5819. @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
  5820. @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
  5821. @end itemize
  5822. @end deffn
  5823. @end deffn
  5824. @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
  5825. @cindex str9xpec
  5826. Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
  5827. Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
  5828. Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
  5829. @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
  5830. Here is some background info to help
  5831. you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
  5832. the str9:
  5833. @enumerate
  5834. @item
  5835. Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
  5836. flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
  5837. @item
  5838. Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
  5839. ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
  5840. core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
  5841. for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
  5842. @end enumerate
  5843. Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
  5844. the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
  5845. configured for flash bank 0.
  5846. @example
  5847. # assert srst, we do not want core running
  5848. # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
  5849. adapter assert srst
  5850. # turn off target polling
  5851. poll off
  5852. # disable str9 core
  5853. str9xpec enable_turbo 0
  5854. # read option bytes
  5855. str9xpec options_read 0
  5856. # re-enable str9 core
  5857. str9xpec disable_turbo 0
  5858. poll on
  5859. reset halt
  5860. @end example
  5861. The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
  5862. When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
  5863. has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
  5864. as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
  5865. Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
  5866. @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
  5867. Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
  5868. @end deffn
  5869. @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
  5870. Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
  5871. directly to the embedded flash controller.
  5872. @end deffn
  5873. @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
  5874. Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
  5875. erase the device.
  5876. @end deffn
  5877. @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
  5878. Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
  5879. @end deffn
  5880. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
  5881. Configure str9 boot bank.
  5882. @end deffn
  5883. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
  5884. Configure str9 lvd source.
  5885. @end deffn
  5886. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
  5887. Configure str9 lvd threshold.
  5888. @end deffn
  5889. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
  5890. Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
  5891. @end deffn
  5892. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
  5893. Read str9 option bytes.
  5894. @end deffn
  5895. @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
  5896. Write str9 option bytes.
  5897. @end deffn
  5898. @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
  5899. unlock str9 device.
  5900. @end deffn
  5901. @end deffn
  5902. @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
  5903. @cindex swm050
  5904. All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
  5905. @example
  5906. flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5907. @end example
  5908. One swm050-specific command is defined:
  5909. @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
  5910. Erases the entire flash bank.
  5911. @end deffn
  5912. @end deffn
  5913. @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
  5914. Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
  5915. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  5916. This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5917. Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
  5918. @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
  5919. Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
  5920. @end deffn
  5921. @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
  5922. Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
  5923. @end deffn
  5924. @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
  5925. Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
  5926. the flash clock.
  5927. @end deffn
  5928. @end deffn
  5929. @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
  5930. W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
  5931. are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
  5932. The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
  5933. correct bank config.
  5934. @example
  5935. flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
  5936. @end example
  5937. @end deffn
  5938. @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
  5939. All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
  5940. This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5941. @end deffn
  5942. @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
  5943. All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
  5944. This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5945. Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
  5946. @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
  5947. Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
  5948. @end deffn
  5949. @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
  5950. Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
  5951. @end deffn
  5952. @end deffn
  5953. @section NAND Flash Commands
  5954. @cindex NAND
  5955. Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
  5956. and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
  5957. commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
  5958. NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
  5959. size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
  5960. number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
  5961. page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
  5962. Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
  5963. of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
  5964. One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
  5965. is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
  5966. ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
  5967. blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
  5968. are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
  5969. manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
  5970. use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
  5971. support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
  5972. that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
  5973. with techniques such as wear leveling.
  5974. Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
  5975. support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
  5976. Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
  5977. Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
  5978. geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
  5979. every 512 bytes of data.
  5980. You will need to make sure that any data you write using
  5981. OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
  5982. that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
  5983. writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
  5984. ECC mode is used.
  5985. The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
  5986. @enumerate
  5987. @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
  5988. @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
  5989. passing parameters as needed by the controller.
  5990. @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
  5991. @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
  5992. such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
  5993. to access that device.
  5994. @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
  5995. @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
  5996. via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
  5997. boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
  5998. de-brick a board.
  5999. @end enumerate
  6000. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
  6001. flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
  6002. This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
  6003. are only 32 bits wide.
  6004. (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
  6005. is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
  6006. Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
  6007. modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
  6008. @anchor{nandconfiguration}
  6009. @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
  6010. @cindex NAND configuration
  6011. NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
  6012. plus some additional configuration that's done after
  6013. OpenOCD has initialized.
  6014. @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
  6015. Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
  6016. after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
  6017. In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
  6018. operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
  6019. they were a single (larger) device.
  6020. In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
  6021. commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
  6022. @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
  6023. initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
  6024. configuration files, not interactively.
  6025. @itemize @bullet
  6026. @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
  6027. in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
  6028. @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
  6029. associated with the NAND device being declared.
  6030. @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
  6031. @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
  6032. commands to the NAND controller.
  6033. @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
  6034. @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
  6035. additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
  6036. for more information.
  6037. @end itemize
  6038. @end deffn
  6039. @deffn Command {nand list}
  6040. Prints a summary of each device declared
  6041. using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
  6042. Note that un-probed devices show no details.
  6043. @example
  6044. > nand list
  6045. #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
  6046. blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
  6047. #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
  6048. blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
  6049. >
  6050. @end example
  6051. @end deffn
  6052. @deffn Command {nand probe} num
  6053. Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
  6054. like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
  6055. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6056. You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
  6057. it with most other NAND commands.
  6058. @end deffn
  6059. @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
  6060. @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
  6061. @cindex NAND reading
  6062. Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
  6063. starting at the specified offset.
  6064. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6065. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6066. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6067. The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
  6068. device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
  6069. associated with each such page may also be accessed.
  6070. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
  6071. was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
  6072. and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
  6073. method which handled that error correction.
  6074. By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
  6075. Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
  6076. @itemize @bullet
  6077. @item no oob_* parameter
  6078. @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
  6079. @item @code{oob_raw}
  6080. @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
  6081. the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
  6082. spare areas associated with each data page.
  6083. Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
  6084. what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
  6085. controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
  6086. @item @code{oob_only}
  6087. @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
  6088. be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
  6089. spare areas associated with each data page.
  6090. @end itemize
  6091. @end deffn
  6092. @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
  6093. @cindex NAND erasing
  6094. @cindex NAND programming
  6095. Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
  6096. specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
  6097. Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
  6098. block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
  6099. If those parameters are not specified,
  6100. the whole NAND chip will be erased.
  6101. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6102. @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
  6103. to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
  6104. block marker.
  6105. For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
  6106. will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
  6107. @end deffn
  6108. @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
  6109. @cindex NAND writing
  6110. @cindex NAND programming
  6111. Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
  6112. starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
  6113. have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
  6114. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6115. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6116. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6117. The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
  6118. All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
  6119. past the end of the device.
  6120. Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
  6121. page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
  6122. if that's being written.)
  6123. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
  6124. ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
  6125. but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
  6126. Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
  6127. NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
  6128. if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
  6129. @itemize @bullet
  6130. @item no oob_* parameter
  6131. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6132. If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
  6133. Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
  6134. a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
  6135. with hardware-computed ECC data.
  6136. @item @code{oob_only}
  6137. @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
  6138. Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
  6139. option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
  6140. You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
  6141. @item @code{oob_raw}
  6142. @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
  6143. If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
  6144. un-altered OOB.
  6145. Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
  6146. a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
  6147. before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
  6148. @item @code{oob_softecc}
  6149. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6150. The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
  6151. software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
  6152. You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
  6153. the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
  6154. @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
  6155. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6156. The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
  6157. specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
  6158. You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
  6159. the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
  6160. @end itemize
  6161. @end deffn
  6162. @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
  6163. @cindex NAND verification
  6164. @cindex NAND programming
  6165. Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
  6166. specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
  6167. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6168. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6169. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6170. The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
  6171. All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
  6172. flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
  6173. As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
  6174. space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
  6175. The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
  6176. and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
  6177. can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
  6178. @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
  6179. driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
  6180. hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
  6181. be removed in a future release.
  6182. @end deffn
  6183. @subsection Other NAND commands
  6184. @cindex NAND other commands
  6185. @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
  6186. Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
  6187. device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
  6188. device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
  6189. continues for @var{length} bytes.
  6190. Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
  6191. block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
  6192. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6193. @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
  6194. with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
  6195. driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
  6196. @end deffn
  6197. @deffn Command {nand info} num
  6198. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6199. This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
  6200. devices which have been probed this also prints any known
  6201. status for each block.
  6202. @end deffn
  6203. @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  6204. Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
  6205. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6206. This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
  6207. value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
  6208. the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
  6209. methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
  6210. this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
  6211. When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
  6212. data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
  6213. writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
  6214. raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
  6215. bypassing hardware ECC logic.
  6216. @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
  6217. with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
  6218. @end deffn
  6219. @anchor{nanddriverlist}
  6220. @subsection NAND Driver List
  6221. As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
  6222. driver-specific options and behaviors.
  6223. Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
  6224. @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
  6225. This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
  6226. Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
  6227. address of the ECC controller.
  6228. @example
  6229. nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
  6230. @end example
  6231. AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
  6232. @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
  6233. disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
  6234. additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
  6235. controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
  6236. @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
  6237. Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
  6238. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6239. @end deffn
  6240. @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
  6241. Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
  6242. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6243. @end deffn
  6244. For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
  6245. properly configured for input or output.
  6246. @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
  6247. Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
  6248. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
  6249. is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
  6250. @end deffn
  6251. @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
  6252. Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
  6253. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
  6254. is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
  6255. @end deffn
  6256. @end deffn
  6257. @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
  6258. This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
  6259. chips from Texas Instruments.
  6260. It takes three extra parameters:
  6261. address of the NAND chip;
  6262. hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
  6263. @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
  6264. address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
  6265. @example
  6266. nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
  6267. @end example
  6268. All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
  6269. and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
  6270. The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
  6271. to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
  6272. the @command{nand raw_access} command.
  6273. @end deffn
  6274. @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
  6275. These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
  6276. parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
  6277. @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
  6278. Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
  6279. MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
  6280. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6281. @end deffn
  6282. At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
  6283. and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
  6284. to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
  6285. in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
  6286. @end deffn
  6287. @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
  6288. @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
  6289. This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
  6290. should work for this chip as well.
  6291. @end deffn
  6292. @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
  6293. This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
  6294. chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
  6295. The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
  6296. @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
  6297. and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
  6298. main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
  6299. @example
  6300. nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
  6301. @end example
  6302. @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
  6303. Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
  6304. without parameter query status.
  6305. @end deffn
  6306. @end deffn
  6307. @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
  6308. These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
  6309. parameter: the address of the controller.
  6310. @example
  6311. nand device orion 0xd8000000
  6312. @end example
  6313. These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
  6314. At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
  6315. or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
  6316. change any behavior.
  6317. @end deffn
  6318. @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
  6319. @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
  6320. @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
  6321. @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
  6322. @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
  6323. These S3C family controllers don't have any special
  6324. @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
  6325. specialized commands.
  6326. At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
  6327. or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
  6328. change any behavior.
  6329. @end deffn
  6330. @node Flash Programming
  6331. @chapter Flash Programming
  6332. OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
  6333. Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
  6334. or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
  6335. @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
  6336. OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
  6337. The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
  6338. @enumerate
  6339. @item 'init' is executed.
  6340. @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
  6341. @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
  6342. @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
  6343. @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
  6344. @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
  6345. @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
  6346. @end enumerate
  6347. An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
  6348. @example
  6349. # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
  6350. # are optional parameters
  6351. openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
  6352. -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
  6353. # binary files need the flash address passing
  6354. openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
  6355. -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
  6356. @end example
  6357. @node PLD/FPGA Commands
  6358. @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
  6359. @cindex PLD
  6360. @cindex FPGA
  6361. Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
  6362. Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
  6363. OpenOCD can support programming them.
  6364. Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
  6365. there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
  6366. they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
  6367. Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
  6368. @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
  6369. As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
  6370. OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
  6371. Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
  6372. They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
  6373. and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
  6374. @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
  6375. Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
  6376. using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
  6377. The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
  6378. behavior.
  6379. @end deffn
  6380. @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
  6381. Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
  6382. @end deffn
  6383. @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
  6384. Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
  6385. The file format must be inferred by the driver.
  6386. @end deffn
  6387. @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
  6388. Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
  6389. definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
  6390. that particular type of PLD.
  6391. @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
  6392. Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
  6393. It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
  6394. If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
  6395. loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
  6396. breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
  6397. @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
  6398. Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
  6399. for FPGA @var{num}.
  6400. @end deffn
  6401. @end deffn
  6402. @node General Commands
  6403. @chapter General Commands
  6404. @cindex commands
  6405. The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
  6406. you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
  6407. commands are documented elsewhere.
  6408. Intent:
  6409. @itemize @bullet
  6410. @item @b{Source Of Commands}
  6411. @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
  6412. elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
  6413. or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
  6414. @item @b{From the human}
  6415. @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
  6416. or via GDB (default port 3333).
  6417. To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
  6418. command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
  6419. command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
  6420. @item @b{Machine Interface}
  6421. The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
  6422. port is 5555.
  6423. @end itemize
  6424. @section Server Commands
  6425. @deffn {Command} exit
  6426. Exits the current telnet session.
  6427. @end deffn
  6428. @deffn {Command} help [string]
  6429. With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
  6430. Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
  6431. Not every command provides helptext.
  6432. Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
  6433. explicitly noted in parenthesis.
  6434. In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
  6435. which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
  6436. @end deffn
  6437. @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
  6438. Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
  6439. If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
  6440. (This option is strongly discouraged.)
  6441. Useful in connection with script files
  6442. (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
  6443. @end deffn
  6444. @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
  6445. Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
  6446. other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
  6447. non-zero exit code to the parent process.
  6448. Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
  6449. @example
  6450. # redefine shutdown
  6451. rename shutdown original_shutdown
  6452. proc shutdown @{@} @{
  6453. puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
  6454. # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
  6455. original_shutdown
  6456. @}
  6457. @end example
  6458. If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
  6459. or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
  6460. @end deffn
  6461. @anchor{debuglevel}
  6462. @deffn Command debug_level [n]
  6463. @cindex message level
  6464. Display debug level.
  6465. If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
  6466. This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
  6467. Level 0 is error messages only;
  6468. level 1 adds warnings;
  6469. level 2 adds informational messages;
  6470. level 3 adds debugging messages;
  6471. and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
  6472. The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
  6473. the command line along with the location of that log
  6474. file (which is normally the server's standard output).
  6475. @xref{Running}.
  6476. @end deffn
  6477. @deffn Command echo [-n] message
  6478. Logs a message at "user" priority.
  6479. Output @var{message} to stdout.
  6480. Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
  6481. @example
  6482. echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
  6483. @end example
  6484. @end deffn
  6485. @deffn Command log_output [filename]
  6486. Redirect logging to @var{filename};
  6487. the initial log output channel is stderr.
  6488. @end deffn
  6489. @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
  6490. Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
  6491. @end deffn
  6492. @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
  6493. Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
  6494. TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
  6495. interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
  6496. 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
  6497. @end deffn
  6498. @anchor{targetstatehandling}
  6499. @section Target State handling
  6500. @cindex reset
  6501. @cindex halt
  6502. @cindex target initialization
  6503. In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
  6504. shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
  6505. These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
  6506. a current target which is used to perform the
  6507. various operations. The current target may be changed
  6508. by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
  6509. target which should become current.
  6510. @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
  6511. Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
  6512. The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
  6513. registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
  6514. registers may be accessible while the target is running.
  6515. @emph{With no arguments}:
  6516. list all available registers for the current target,
  6517. showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
  6518. For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
  6519. which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
  6520. are flagged as such.
  6521. @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
  6522. Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
  6523. bypassing any internal cache.
  6524. @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
  6525. Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
  6526. so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
  6527. of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
  6528. (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
  6529. relevant module will flush such values.
  6530. Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
  6531. Debug and trace infrastructure:
  6532. @example
  6533. > reg
  6534. ===== ARM registers
  6535. (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
  6536. (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
  6537. (2) r2 (/32)
  6538. ...
  6539. (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
  6540. >
  6541. @end example
  6542. @end deffn
  6543. @deffn Command halt [ms]
  6544. @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
  6545. The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
  6546. which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
  6547. Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
  6548. or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
  6549. (and enter debug mode).
  6550. Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
  6551. @quotation Warning
  6552. On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
  6553. often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
  6554. This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
  6555. power mode by gating the core clock;
  6556. but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
  6557. One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
  6558. interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
  6559. at least until the interrupt handler completes.
  6560. However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
  6561. and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
  6562. Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
  6563. A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
  6564. work with a JTAG debugger.
  6565. Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
  6566. @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
  6567. (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
  6568. newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
  6569. Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
  6570. power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
  6571. @end quotation
  6572. @end deffn
  6573. @deffn Command resume [address]
  6574. Resume the target at its current code position,
  6575. or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
  6576. OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
  6577. @end deffn
  6578. @deffn Command step [address]
  6579. Single-step the target at its current code position,
  6580. or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
  6581. @end deffn
  6582. @anchor{resetcommand}
  6583. @deffn Command reset
  6584. @deffnx Command {reset run}
  6585. @deffnx Command {reset halt}
  6586. @deffnx Command {reset init}
  6587. Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
  6588. @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
  6589. events will fire during the reset sequence.}
  6590. The optional parameter specifies what should
  6591. happen after the reset.
  6592. If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
  6593. The other options will not work on all systems.
  6594. @xref{Reset Configuration}.
  6595. @itemize @minus
  6596. @item @b{run} Let the target run
  6597. @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
  6598. @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
  6599. @end itemize
  6600. @end deffn
  6601. @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
  6602. Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
  6603. when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
  6604. released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
  6605. then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
  6606. the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
  6607. state.
  6608. @end deffn
  6609. @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
  6610. @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
  6611. Set values of reset signals.
  6612. Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
  6613. The @var{signal} parameter values may be
  6614. @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
  6615. @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
  6616. The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
  6617. to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
  6618. signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
  6619. @xref{Reset Configuration}.
  6620. Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
  6621. If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
  6622. the signal will not be modified.
  6623. @quotation Note
  6624. TRST is specially handled.
  6625. It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
  6626. So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
  6627. or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
  6628. JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
  6629. instead of the TRST signal.
  6630. And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
  6631. the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
  6632. TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
  6633. with handlers for that event.
  6634. @end quotation
  6635. @end deffn
  6636. @section I/O Utilities
  6637. These commands are available when
  6638. OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
  6639. They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
  6640. notably the ZY1000.
  6641. Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
  6642. @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
  6643. @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
  6644. Appends the @var{string} parameters to
  6645. the text file @file{filename}.
  6646. Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
  6647. The last string is followed by a newline.
  6648. @end deffn
  6649. @deffn Command cat filename
  6650. Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
  6651. @end deffn
  6652. @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
  6653. Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
  6654. into @file{dest_filename}.
  6655. @end deffn
  6656. @deffn Command ip
  6657. @emph{No description provided.}
  6658. @end deffn
  6659. @deffn Command ls
  6660. @emph{No description provided.}
  6661. @end deffn
  6662. @deffn Command mac
  6663. @emph{No description provided.}
  6664. @end deffn
  6665. @deffn Command meminfo
  6666. Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
  6667. Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
  6668. @end deffn
  6669. @deffn Command peek
  6670. @emph{No description provided.}
  6671. @end deffn
  6672. @deffn Command poke
  6673. @emph{No description provided.}
  6674. @end deffn
  6675. @deffn Command rm filename
  6676. @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
  6677. Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
  6678. @end deffn
  6679. @deffn Command trunc filename
  6680. Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
  6681. @end deffn
  6682. @anchor{memoryaccess}
  6683. @section Memory access commands
  6684. @cindex memory access
  6685. These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
  6686. system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
  6687. special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
  6688. SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
  6689. @enumerate
  6690. @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
  6691. to change the current target.
  6692. @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
  6693. Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
  6694. about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
  6695. @end enumerate
  6696. @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
  6697. @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
  6698. @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
  6699. @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
  6700. Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
  6701. 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
  6702. 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
  6703. or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
  6704. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  6705. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  6706. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  6707. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  6708. If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
  6709. (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
  6710. see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
  6711. @end deffn
  6712. @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
  6713. @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
  6714. @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
  6715. @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
  6716. Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
  6717. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
  6718. at the specified address @var{addr}.
  6719. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  6720. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  6721. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  6722. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  6723. If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
  6724. @end deffn
  6725. @anchor{imageaccess}
  6726. @section Image loading commands
  6727. @cindex image loading
  6728. @cindex image dumping
  6729. @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
  6730. Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
  6731. binary file named @var{filename}.
  6732. @end deffn
  6733. @deffn Command {fast_load}
  6734. Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
  6735. current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
  6736. @end deffn
  6737. @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
  6738. Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
  6739. testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
  6740. host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
  6741. can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
  6742. Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
  6743. memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
  6744. target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
  6745. separately.
  6746. @end deffn
  6747. @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
  6748. Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
  6749. The file format may optionally be specified
  6750. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
  6751. In addition the following arguments may be specified:
  6752. @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
  6753. @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
  6754. @example
  6755. proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
  6756. # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
  6757. # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
  6758. load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
  6759. $address $length
  6760. @}
  6761. @end example
  6762. @end deffn
  6763. @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
  6764. Displays image section sizes and addresses
  6765. as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
  6766. starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
  6767. The file format may optionally be specified
  6768. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  6769. @end deffn
  6770. @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
  6771. Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
  6772. The file format may optionally be specified
  6773. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  6774. This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
  6775. @end deffn
  6776. @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
  6777. Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
  6778. The file format may optionally be specified
  6779. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  6780. This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
  6781. @end deffn
  6782. @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
  6783. @cindex breakpoint
  6784. @cindex watchpoint
  6785. CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
  6786. hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
  6787. watchpoints.
  6788. In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
  6789. @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
  6790. With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
  6791. Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
  6792. at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  6793. This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
  6794. in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
  6795. (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
  6796. for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
  6797. @end deffn
  6798. @deffn Command {rbp} address
  6799. Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
  6800. @end deffn
  6801. @deffn Command {rwp} address
  6802. Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
  6803. @end deffn
  6804. @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
  6805. With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
  6806. Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  6807. The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
  6808. the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
  6809. defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
  6810. If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
  6811. the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
  6812. using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
  6813. @end deffn
  6814. @section Misc Commands
  6815. @cindex profiling
  6816. @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
  6817. Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
  6818. which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
  6819. Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
  6820. format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
  6821. limit the address range.
  6822. @end deffn
  6823. @deffn Command {version}
  6824. Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
  6825. @end deffn
  6826. @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
  6827. Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
  6828. to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
  6829. @end deffn
  6830. @node Architecture and Core Commands
  6831. @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
  6832. @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
  6833. @cindex Core Specific Commands
  6834. Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
  6835. OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
  6836. Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
  6837. exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
  6838. @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
  6839. @section ARM Hardware Tracing
  6840. @cindex tracing
  6841. @cindex ETM
  6842. @cindex ETB
  6843. CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
  6844. based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
  6845. address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
  6846. @itemize
  6847. @item
  6848. Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
  6849. trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
  6850. supports such an interface.
  6851. (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
  6852. and trace port support.)
  6853. Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
  6854. and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
  6855. buffer several megabytes of trace data.
  6856. Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
  6857. in the board-specific configuration file.
  6858. @item
  6859. If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
  6860. has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
  6861. dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
  6862. Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
  6863. (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
  6864. @end itemize
  6865. ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
  6866. @quotation Issues
  6867. ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
  6868. parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
  6869. ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
  6870. hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
  6871. watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
  6872. @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
  6873. dummy trace port driver}.
  6874. It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
  6875. as well as tracing only during specific states
  6876. (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
  6877. There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
  6878. analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
  6879. It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
  6880. with the current XScale trace support, or should be
  6881. shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
  6882. At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
  6883. for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
  6884. work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
  6885. this original style of JTAG access.
  6886. @end quotation
  6887. @subsection ETM Configuration
  6888. ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
  6889. @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
  6890. Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
  6891. with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
  6892. Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
  6893. which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
  6894. using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
  6895. that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
  6896. The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
  6897. except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
  6898. support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
  6899. (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
  6900. the selected port width and mode are supported.)
  6901. The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
  6902. or @option{demultiplexed}.
  6903. The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
  6904. @quotation Warning
  6905. With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
  6906. @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
  6907. This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
  6908. previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
  6909. @end quotation
  6910. @quotation Note
  6911. You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
  6912. Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
  6913. Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
  6914. what CPU activities are traced.
  6915. @end quotation
  6916. @end deffn
  6917. @deffn Command {etm info}
  6918. Displays information about the current target's ETM.
  6919. This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
  6920. as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
  6921. from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
  6922. @end deffn
  6923. @deffn Command {etm status}
  6924. Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
  6925. is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
  6926. Did trace data overflow?
  6927. Was it triggered?
  6928. @end deffn
  6929. @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
  6930. Displays what data that ETM will collect.
  6931. If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
  6932. When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
  6933. and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
  6934. @itemize
  6935. @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
  6936. when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
  6937. The value is one of
  6938. @option{none} (save nothing),
  6939. @option{data} (save data),
  6940. @option{address} (save addresses),
  6941. @option{all} (save data and addresses)
  6942. @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
  6943. @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
  6944. cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
  6945. Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
  6946. @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
  6947. Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
  6948. trace stream without an image of the code.
  6949. @end itemize
  6950. @end deffn
  6951. @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  6952. Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
  6953. enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
  6954. The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
  6955. Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
  6956. By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
  6957. processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
  6958. more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
  6959. @end deffn
  6960. @subsection ETM Trace Operation
  6961. After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
  6962. That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
  6963. It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
  6964. To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
  6965. various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
  6966. For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
  6967. @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
  6968. Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
  6969. and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
  6970. of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
  6971. Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
  6972. @itemize
  6973. @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
  6974. it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
  6975. for instruction access within that function's body.
  6976. @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
  6977. it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
  6978. tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
  6979. exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
  6980. @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
  6981. combining one of the above models with a counter.
  6982. @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
  6983. using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
  6984. @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
  6985. model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
  6986. @item @emph{... more}
  6987. @end itemize
  6988. At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
  6989. procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
  6990. @deffn Command {etm analyze}
  6991. Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
  6992. Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
  6993. @end deffn
  6994. @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
  6995. Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
  6996. @end deffn
  6997. @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
  6998. Opens an image file.
  6999. @end deffn
  7000. @deffn Command {etm load} filename
  7001. Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
  7002. @end deffn
  7003. @deffn Command {etm start}
  7004. Starts trace data collection.
  7005. @end deffn
  7006. @deffn Command {etm stop}
  7007. Stops trace data collection.
  7008. @end deffn
  7009. @anchor{traceportdrivers}
  7010. @subsection Trace Port Drivers
  7011. To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
  7012. @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
  7013. Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
  7014. not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
  7015. @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
  7016. any trace data collection.}
  7017. @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
  7018. Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
  7019. @end deffn
  7020. @end deffn
  7021. @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
  7022. Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
  7023. to use on-chip ETB memory.
  7024. @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
  7025. Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
  7026. You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
  7027. @end deffn
  7028. @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
  7029. This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
  7030. ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
  7031. It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
  7032. trace trigger becomes active.
  7033. @itemize
  7034. @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
  7035. recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
  7036. afterwards.
  7037. @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
  7038. recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
  7039. Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
  7040. what caused that event to happen.
  7041. @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
  7042. recording data almost exclusively after the event.
  7043. This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
  7044. how the event caused trouble.
  7045. @end itemize
  7046. @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
  7047. @end deffn
  7048. @end deffn
  7049. @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
  7050. This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
  7051. with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
  7052. to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
  7053. it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
  7054. Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
  7055. connected to an off-chip trace connector.
  7056. @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
  7057. Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
  7058. collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
  7059. @end deffn
  7060. @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
  7061. Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
  7062. @end deffn
  7063. @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
  7064. Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
  7065. @end deffn
  7066. @end deffn
  7067. @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
  7068. @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
  7069. @cindex CTI
  7070. The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
  7071. that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
  7072. other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
  7073. CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
  7074. CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
  7075. the @emph{cti} group of commands.
  7076. @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
  7077. Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
  7078. @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
  7079. on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
  7080. new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
  7081. including additional configuration.
  7082. @end deffn
  7083. @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
  7084. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
  7085. @end deffn
  7086. @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
  7087. Displays a register dump of the CTI.
  7088. @end deffn
  7089. @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
  7090. Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
  7091. @end deffn
  7092. @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
  7093. Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
  7094. @end deffn
  7095. @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
  7096. Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
  7097. @end deffn
  7098. @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
  7099. Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
  7100. gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
  7101. @end deffn
  7102. @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
  7103. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
  7104. of the CTI.
  7105. @end deffn
  7106. @deffn Command {cti names}
  7107. Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
  7108. useful in TCL scripting.
  7109. @end deffn
  7110. @section Generic ARM
  7111. @cindex ARM
  7112. These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
  7113. They are available in addition to other core-specific
  7114. commands that may be available.
  7115. @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
  7116. Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
  7117. either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
  7118. The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
  7119. (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
  7120. that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
  7121. @end deffn
  7122. @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
  7123. @cindex disassemble
  7124. Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
  7125. If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
  7126. If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
  7127. Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
  7128. else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
  7129. (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
  7130. those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
  7131. Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
  7132. so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
  7133. see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
  7134. Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
  7135. with a handful of exceptions.
  7136. ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
  7137. @end deffn
  7138. @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
  7139. Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
  7140. passing parameters @var{CRn},
  7141. @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
  7142. and using the MCR instruction.
  7143. (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
  7144. an ARM register.)
  7145. @end deffn
  7146. @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
  7147. Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
  7148. @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
  7149. and the MRC instruction.
  7150. Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
  7151. (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
  7152. an ARM register.)
  7153. @end deffn
  7154. @deffn Command {arm reg}
  7155. Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
  7156. core mode if necessary.
  7157. @end deffn
  7158. @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7159. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7160. Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
  7161. Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
  7162. I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
  7163. is running. The target application must be linked against a library
  7164. implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
  7165. requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
  7166. Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
  7167. @end deffn
  7168. @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7169. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7170. Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
  7171. @example
  7172. arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
  7173. @end example
  7174. This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
  7175. the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
  7176. standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
  7177. programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
  7178. @end deffn
  7179. @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7180. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7181. Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
  7182. status.
  7183. Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
  7184. File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
  7185. interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
  7186. debugger.
  7187. @end deffn
  7188. @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7189. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7190. Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
  7191. When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
  7192. things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
  7193. the value returned by the target.
  7194. When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
  7195. by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
  7196. debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
  7197. encountering a break.
  7198. In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
  7199. return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
  7200. to the debugger.
  7201. The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
  7202. to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
  7203. request or equivalent").
  7204. To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
  7205. this option (default: disabled).
  7206. @end deffn
  7207. @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
  7208. @cindex ARMv4
  7209. @cindex ARMv5
  7210. The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
  7211. and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
  7212. That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
  7213. variant.
  7214. @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
  7215. @cindex ARM7
  7216. @cindex ARM9
  7217. These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
  7218. ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
  7219. They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
  7220. and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
  7221. @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7222. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
  7223. the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
  7224. instead of breakpoints.
  7225. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7226. This should be
  7227. safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
  7228. This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
  7229. including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
  7230. @end deffn
  7231. @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7232. @cindex DCC
  7233. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
  7234. channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
  7235. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7236. DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
  7237. unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
  7238. with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
  7239. @end deffn
  7240. @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7241. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
  7242. that don't check completion of the operation.
  7243. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7244. This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
  7245. cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
  7246. speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
  7247. @end deffn
  7248. @subsection ARM720T specific commands
  7249. @cindex ARM720T
  7250. These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
  7251. which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
  7252. based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
  7253. They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
  7254. @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
  7255. @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
  7256. Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
  7257. Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
  7258. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7259. The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
  7260. @end deffn
  7261. @subsection ARM9 specific commands
  7262. @cindex ARM9
  7263. ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
  7264. integer processors.
  7265. Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
  7266. @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
  7267. @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
  7268. @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
  7269. @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
  7270. @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
  7271. @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
  7272. @cindex vector_catch
  7273. Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
  7274. for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
  7275. You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
  7276. so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
  7277. to those hardware vectors.
  7278. This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
  7279. If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
  7280. vector catch hardware to intercept
  7281. @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
  7282. @option{none} of them,
  7283. or a list with one or more of the following:
  7284. @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
  7285. @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
  7286. @end deffn
  7287. @subsection ARM920T specific commands
  7288. @cindex ARM920T
  7289. These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
  7290. which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
  7291. built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
  7292. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7293. and ARM9 commands.
  7294. @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
  7295. Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
  7296. is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
  7297. @end deffn
  7298. @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
  7299. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7300. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7301. This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
  7302. shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
  7303. (Not all registers can be written.)
  7304. @end deffn
  7305. @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
  7306. @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
  7307. Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
  7308. Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
  7309. be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
  7310. (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
  7311. If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
  7312. Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
  7313. or using zero if no other address is provided.
  7314. @end deffn
  7315. @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
  7316. Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
  7317. @end deffn
  7318. @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
  7319. Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
  7320. @end deffn
  7321. @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
  7322. @cindex ARM926ej-s
  7323. These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
  7324. which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
  7325. based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
  7326. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7327. and ARM9 commands.
  7328. The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
  7329. they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
  7330. @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
  7331. Print information about the caches found.
  7332. @end deffn
  7333. @subsection ARM966E specific commands
  7334. @cindex ARM966E
  7335. These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
  7336. which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
  7337. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7338. and ARM9 commands.
  7339. @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
  7340. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7341. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7342. The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
  7343. ARM966E-S TRM.
  7344. There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
  7345. as required for BIST support.
  7346. @end deffn
  7347. @subsection XScale specific commands
  7348. @cindex XScale
  7349. Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
  7350. The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
  7351. (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
  7352. code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
  7353. must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
  7354. handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
  7355. mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
  7356. handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
  7357. To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
  7358. vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
  7359. individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
  7360. the mini-IC.
  7361. It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
  7362. table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
  7363. makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
  7364. code layout in memory:
  7365. @example
  7366. _vectors:
  7367. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7368. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7369. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7370. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7371. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7372. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7373. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7374. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7375. .org 0x100
  7376. .long real_reset_vector
  7377. .long real_ui_handler
  7378. .long real_swi_handler
  7379. .long real_pf_abort
  7380. .long real_data_abort
  7381. .long 0 /* unused */
  7382. .long real_irq_handler
  7383. .long real_fiq_handler
  7384. @end example
  7385. Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
  7386. vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
  7387. system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
  7388. is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
  7389. using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
  7390. value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
  7391. halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
  7392. table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
  7393. that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
  7394. need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
  7395. start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
  7396. but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
  7397. accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
  7398. been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
  7399. in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
  7400. situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
  7401. software.
  7402. The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
  7403. the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
  7404. debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
  7405. 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
  7406. XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
  7407. watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
  7408. functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
  7409. command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
  7410. power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
  7411. watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
  7412. four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
  7413. at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
  7414. length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
  7415. These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
  7416. which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
  7417. @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
  7418. Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
  7419. @end deffn
  7420. @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
  7421. Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
  7422. @end deffn
  7423. @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
  7424. Displays information about the CPU caches.
  7425. @end deffn
  7426. @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
  7427. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7428. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7429. @end deffn
  7430. @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
  7431. Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
  7432. @end deffn
  7433. @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7434. Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
  7435. @end deffn
  7436. @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
  7437. Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
  7438. @end deffn
  7439. @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7440. Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
  7441. @end deffn
  7442. @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7443. Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
  7444. @end deffn
  7445. @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
  7446. Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
  7447. enabling or disabling the trace buffer
  7448. and modifying how it is emptied.
  7449. @end deffn
  7450. @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
  7451. Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
  7452. its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
  7453. The image @var{type} may be one of
  7454. @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
  7455. @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
  7456. @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
  7457. @end deffn
  7458. @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
  7459. @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
  7460. @cindex vector_catch
  7461. Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
  7462. If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
  7463. The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
  7464. @example
  7465. 0x01 Trap Reset
  7466. 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
  7467. 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
  7468. 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
  7469. 0x10 Trap Data Abort
  7470. 0x20 reserved
  7471. 0x40 Trap IRQ
  7472. 0x80 Trap FIQ
  7473. @end example
  7474. @end deffn
  7475. @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
  7476. @cindex vector_table
  7477. Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
  7478. low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
  7479. holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
  7480. points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
  7481. @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
  7482. Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
  7483. @end deffn
  7484. @section ARMv6 Architecture
  7485. @cindex ARMv6
  7486. @subsection ARM11 specific commands
  7487. @cindex ARM11
  7488. @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7489. Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
  7490. which is enabled by default.
  7491. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7492. Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
  7493. They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
  7494. word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
  7495. instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
  7496. This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
  7497. @end deffn
  7498. @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7499. Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
  7500. which is enabled by default.
  7501. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7502. When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
  7503. @end deffn
  7504. @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7505. Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
  7506. IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
  7507. they are disabled by default.
  7508. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
  7509. @end deffn
  7510. @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
  7511. @cindex vector_catch
  7512. Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
  7513. coprocessor 14 register 7.
  7514. If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
  7515. Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
  7516. for certain hardware events.
  7517. The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
  7518. coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
  7519. cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
  7520. @end deffn
  7521. @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
  7522. @cindex ARMv7
  7523. @cindex ARMv8
  7524. @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
  7525. @cindex Cortex-A
  7526. @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
  7527. display information about target caches
  7528. @end deffn
  7529. @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
  7530. Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
  7531. mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
  7532. to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
  7533. Defaults to 'off'.
  7534. @end deffn
  7535. @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
  7536. Initialize core debug
  7537. Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
  7538. @end deffn
  7539. @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
  7540. Display/set the current SMP mode
  7541. @end deffn
  7542. @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
  7543. Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
  7544. @end deffn
  7545. @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  7546. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
  7547. @end deffn
  7548. @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
  7549. configure l2x cache
  7550. @end deffn
  7551. @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
  7552. Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
  7553. memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
  7554. @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
  7555. possible (4096) entries are printed.
  7556. @end deffn
  7557. @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
  7558. @cindex Cortex-R
  7559. @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
  7560. Initialize core debug
  7561. Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
  7562. @end deffn
  7563. @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  7564. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
  7565. @end deffn
  7566. @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
  7567. @cindex tracing
  7568. @cindex SWO
  7569. @cindex SWV
  7570. @cindex TPIU
  7571. @cindex ITM
  7572. @cindex ETM
  7573. @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
  7574. (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
  7575. @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
  7576. ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
  7577. information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
  7578. through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
  7579. configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
  7580. This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
  7581. capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
  7582. debugger adapter features.
  7583. Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
  7584. @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
  7585. Command options:
  7586. @itemize @minus
  7587. @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
  7588. @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
  7589. output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
  7590. @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
  7591. gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
  7592. either a regular file or a named pipe);
  7593. @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
  7594. gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
  7595. @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
  7596. mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
  7597. @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
  7598. coding;
  7599. @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
  7600. regular UART 8N1) coding;
  7601. @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
  7602. or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
  7603. data is to be output via SWO;
  7604. @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
  7605. current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
  7606. @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
  7607. internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
  7608. rate automatically.
  7609. @end itemize
  7610. Example usage:
  7611. @enumerate
  7612. @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
  7613. PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
  7614. enough to:
  7615. @example
  7616. #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
  7617. ...
  7618. ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
  7619. ...
  7620. @end example
  7621. (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
  7622. for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
  7623. blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
  7624. ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
  7625. @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
  7626. @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
  7627. @example
  7628. $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
  7629. $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
  7630. @end example
  7631. (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
  7632. baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
  7633. @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
  7634. @item OpenOCD invocation line:
  7635. @example
  7636. openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
  7637. -c "transport select hla_swd" \
  7638. -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
  7639. -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
  7640. @end example
  7641. @end enumerate
  7642. @end deffn
  7643. @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
  7644. Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
  7645. from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
  7646. @end deffn
  7647. @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
  7648. Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
  7649. @end deffn
  7650. @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
  7651. @cindex Cortex-M
  7652. @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
  7653. Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
  7654. The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
  7655. get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
  7656. pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
  7657. the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
  7658. are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
  7659. the step command leaves with the core running.
  7660. The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
  7661. enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
  7662. for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
  7663. FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
  7664. Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
  7665. option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
  7666. is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
  7667. does.
  7668. Default is @option{auto}.
  7669. @end deffn
  7670. @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
  7671. @cindex vector_catch
  7672. Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
  7673. for certain hardware events.
  7674. Parameters request interception of
  7675. @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
  7676. @option{none} of them,
  7677. or one or more of the following:
  7678. @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
  7679. @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
  7680. @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
  7681. @option{irq_err},
  7682. @option{state_err},
  7683. @option{chk_err}, or
  7684. @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
  7685. @option{reset}.
  7686. If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
  7687. MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
  7688. are mapped to HardFault.
  7689. UsageFault checks for
  7690. divide-by-zero and unaligned access
  7691. must also be explicitly enabled.
  7692. This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
  7693. @end deffn
  7694. @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
  7695. Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
  7696. @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
  7697. @itemize @minus
  7698. @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
  7699. @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
  7700. @end itemize
  7701. Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
  7702. This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
  7703. are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
  7704. to manually reset the peripherals.
  7705. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  7706. Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
  7707. instead.
  7708. @end deffn
  7709. @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
  7710. @cindex ARMv8-A
  7711. @cindex aarch64
  7712. @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
  7713. Display information about target caches
  7714. @end deffn
  7715. @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
  7716. This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
  7717. indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
  7718. target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
  7719. @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
  7720. However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
  7721. @end deffn
  7722. @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
  7723. Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
  7724. are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
  7725. halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
  7726. group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
  7727. @end deffn
  7728. @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  7729. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
  7730. @option{on}.
  7731. @end deffn
  7732. @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
  7733. Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
  7734. Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
  7735. @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
  7736. the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
  7737. Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
  7738. @end deffn
  7739. @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
  7740. eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
  7741. provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
  7742. @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
  7743. @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
  7744. Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
  7745. option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
  7746. @end deffn
  7747. @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
  7748. Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
  7749. control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
  7750. @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
  7751. By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
  7752. @end deffn
  7753. @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
  7754. @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
  7755. Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
  7756. when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
  7757. @end deffn
  7758. @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
  7759. eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
  7760. data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
  7761. is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
  7762. peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
  7763. formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
  7764. fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
  7765. can be collected.
  7766. OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
  7767. needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
  7768. tooling.
  7769. @quotation Issues
  7770. OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
  7771. for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
  7772. which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
  7773. @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
  7774. It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
  7775. responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
  7776. managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
  7777. software operation on the CPU.
  7778. @end quotation
  7779. @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
  7780. Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
  7781. option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
  7782. is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
  7783. @end deffn
  7784. @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
  7785. Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
  7786. @end deffn
  7787. @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  7788. Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
  7789. control is disabled.
  7790. @end deffn
  7791. @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
  7792. Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
  7793. must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
  7794. to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
  7795. Supported trace formats:
  7796. @itemize
  7797. @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
  7798. timing to be determined.
  7799. @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
  7800. addresses.
  7801. @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
  7802. @end itemize
  7803. @end deffn
  7804. @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
  7805. Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
  7806. brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
  7807. these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
  7808. Supported conditions:
  7809. @itemize
  7810. @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
  7811. @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
  7812. @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
  7813. instruction matches start data and mask.
  7814. @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
  7815. instruction matches start data and mask.
  7816. @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
  7817. data and mask.
  7818. @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
  7819. @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
  7820. @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
  7821. @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
  7822. @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
  7823. @end itemize
  7824. @end deffn
  7825. @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
  7826. Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
  7827. description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
  7828. values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
  7829. Supported conditions:
  7830. @itemize
  7831. @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
  7832. @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
  7833. @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
  7834. instruction matches stop data and mask.
  7835. @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
  7836. instruction matches stop data and mask.
  7837. @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
  7838. data and mask.
  7839. @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
  7840. @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
  7841. @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
  7842. @end itemize
  7843. @end deffn
  7844. @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
  7845. Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
  7846. Supported triggers:
  7847. @itemize
  7848. @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
  7849. @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
  7850. @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
  7851. @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
  7852. collection.
  7853. @end itemize
  7854. @end deffn
  7855. @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
  7856. @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
  7857. Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
  7858. configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
  7859. be overwritten when trace collection starts.
  7860. @end deffn
  7861. @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
  7862. Display trace configuration.
  7863. @end deffn
  7864. @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
  7865. Display trace collection status.
  7866. @end deffn
  7867. @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
  7868. Start manual trace collection.
  7869. @end deffn
  7870. @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
  7871. Stop manual trace collection.
  7872. @end deffn
  7873. @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
  7874. Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
  7875. has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
  7876. copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
  7877. @option{size} options using DMA.
  7878. @end deffn
  7879. @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
  7880. Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
  7881. buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
  7882. be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
  7883. @option{size} options using DMA.
  7884. @end deffn
  7885. @section Intel Architecture
  7886. Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
  7887. (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
  7888. Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
  7889. software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
  7890. Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
  7891. @itemize
  7892. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
  7893. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
  7894. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
  7895. @end itemize
  7896. @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
  7897. The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
  7898. These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
  7899. @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
  7900. Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7901. @end deffn
  7902. @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
  7903. Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7904. @end deffn
  7905. @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
  7906. Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7907. @end deffn
  7908. @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
  7909. Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7910. @end deffn
  7911. @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
  7912. Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7913. @end deffn
  7914. @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
  7915. Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  7916. @end deffn
  7917. @section OpenRISC Architecture
  7918. The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
  7919. configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
  7920. @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
  7921. @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
  7922. Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
  7923. @end deffn
  7924. @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
  7925. Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
  7926. An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
  7927. When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
  7928. configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
  7929. between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
  7930. @end deffn
  7931. @subsection Registers commands
  7932. @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
  7933. Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
  7934. included in the generated target descriptor file.
  7935. @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
  7936. @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
  7937. "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
  7938. and "timer" groups.
  7939. @emph{example:}
  7940. @example
  7941. addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
  7942. @end example
  7943. @end deffn
  7944. @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
  7945. Display all registers in @emph{group}.
  7946. @emph{group} can be "system",
  7947. "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
  7948. "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
  7949. @end deffn
  7950. @section RISC-V Architecture
  7951. @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
  7952. debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
  7953. harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
  7954. RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
  7955. Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
  7956. implement version 0.11.
  7957. @subsection RISC-V Terminology
  7958. A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
  7959. another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
  7960. OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
  7961. @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
  7962. @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
  7963. Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
  7964. standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
  7965. By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
  7966. and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
  7967. command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
  7968. CSRs.
  7969. @end deffn
  7970. @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
  7971. The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
  7972. through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
  7973. configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
  7974. indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
  7975. This command must be executed before `init`.
  7976. @end deffn
  7977. @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
  7978. Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
  7979. should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
  7980. @end deffn
  7981. @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
  7982. Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
  7983. deasserted.
  7984. @end deffn
  7985. @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
  7986. Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
  7987. This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
  7988. @end deffn
  7989. @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
  7990. When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
  7991. use the Program Buffer to access memory.
  7992. @end deffn
  7993. @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
  7994. Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
  7995. example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
  7996. way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
  7997. values.
  7998. When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
  7999. @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
  8000. and DBUS registers, respectively.
  8001. @end deffn
  8002. @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
  8003. The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
  8004. trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
  8005. configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
  8006. @example
  8007. set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
  8008. riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
  8009. @end example
  8010. @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
  8011. Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
  8012. @end deffn
  8013. @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
  8014. Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
  8015. @end deffn
  8016. @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
  8017. The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
  8018. can be used to interact with custom debug features.
  8019. @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
  8020. Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
  8021. @end deffn
  8022. @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
  8023. Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
  8024. @end deffn
  8025. @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
  8026. @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
  8027. @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
  8028. @cindex tracing
  8029. @cindex libdcc
  8030. @cindex DCC
  8031. OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
  8032. the target uses appropriate libraries.
  8033. The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
  8034. a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
  8035. Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
  8036. is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
  8037. These messages are received as part of target polling, so
  8038. you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
  8039. They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
  8040. times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
  8041. See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
  8042. In addition to sending strings, characters, and
  8043. arrays of various size integers from the target,
  8044. @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
  8045. The target being debugged may
  8046. issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
  8047. Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
  8048. each supported by a command:
  8049. @itemize
  8050. @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
  8051. can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
  8052. This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
  8053. finding out how some fault was triggered.
  8054. The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
  8055. It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
  8056. particular event, and other bits to hold data.
  8057. @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
  8058. and then displayed at any time.
  8059. This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
  8060. The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
  8061. number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
  8062. @end itemize
  8063. Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
  8064. via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
  8065. depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
  8066. deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
  8067. This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
  8068. Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
  8069. does the same thing.
  8070. @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
  8071. Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
  8072. These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
  8073. The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
  8074. both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
  8075. With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
  8076. as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
  8077. otherwise the libdcc format is used.
  8078. @end deffn
  8079. @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
  8080. With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
  8081. in the order they triggered.
  8082. With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
  8083. With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
  8084. history records.
  8085. @end deffn
  8086. @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
  8087. With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
  8088. they have been triggered.
  8089. With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
  8090. With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
  8091. and associates it with that identifier.
  8092. @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
  8093. are not related except by this command.
  8094. These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
  8095. or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
  8096. @end deffn
  8097. @node JTAG Commands
  8098. @chapter JTAG Commands
  8099. @cindex JTAG Commands
  8100. Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
  8101. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
  8102. Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
  8103. may be needed to work with targets which require special
  8104. attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
  8105. To use these commands you will need to understand some
  8106. of the basics of JTAG, including:
  8107. @itemize @bullet
  8108. @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
  8109. devices such as a CPUs.
  8110. @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
  8111. standard state machine (in parallel)
  8112. using their shared TMS and clock signals.
  8113. @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
  8114. instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
  8115. while the reading previous ones.
  8116. @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
  8117. a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
  8118. All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
  8119. @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
  8120. shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
  8121. registers.
  8122. @end itemize
  8123. @section Low Level JTAG Commands
  8124. These commands are used by developers who need to access
  8125. JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
  8126. the order of TAP state transitions.
  8127. If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
  8128. new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
  8129. JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
  8130. In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8131. these commands are not available.
  8132. @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
  8133. Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
  8134. that specify the entire register.
  8135. Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
  8136. a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
  8137. The return value holds the original value of each
  8138. of those fields.
  8139. For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
  8140. field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
  8141. @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
  8142. than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
  8143. support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
  8144. All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
  8145. The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
  8146. When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
  8147. in that state.
  8148. For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
  8149. instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
  8150. If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
  8151. @quotation Warning
  8152. OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
  8153. so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
  8154. Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
  8155. data registers, which may have different lengths.
  8156. Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
  8157. the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
  8158. the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
  8159. (by connecting a different scan chain).
  8160. @end quotation
  8161. @end deffn
  8162. @deffn Command {flush_count}
  8163. Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
  8164. This may be used for performance tuning.
  8165. For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
  8166. minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
  8167. not change with the amount of data which is written.
  8168. You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
  8169. tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
  8170. instead of batching them into larger operations.
  8171. @end deffn
  8172. @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
  8173. For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
  8174. with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
  8175. (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
  8176. using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
  8177. For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
  8178. When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
  8179. in that state.
  8180. For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
  8181. can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
  8182. If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
  8183. @quotation Note
  8184. OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
  8185. register values, unlike data register values.
  8186. For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
  8187. portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
  8188. @end quotation
  8189. @end deffn
  8190. @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
  8191. Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
  8192. must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
  8193. Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
  8194. current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
  8195. Then, in a series of single state transitions
  8196. (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
  8197. each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
  8198. The final state must also be stable.
  8199. @end deffn
  8200. @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
  8201. Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
  8202. @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
  8203. Instructions often need some time
  8204. to execute before they take effect.
  8205. @end deffn
  8206. @c tms_sequence (short|long)
  8207. @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
  8208. @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  8209. Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
  8210. during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
  8211. overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
  8212. This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
  8213. @end deffn
  8214. @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  8215. Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
  8216. programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
  8217. must also be enabled.
  8218. Default is enabled.
  8219. @end deffn
  8220. @section TAP state names
  8221. @cindex TAP state names
  8222. The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
  8223. @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
  8224. as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
  8225. SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
  8226. @itemize @bullet
  8227. @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
  8228. acts as if TRST were pulsed
  8229. @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
  8230. @item @b{DRSELECT}
  8231. @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
  8232. @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
  8233. through the data register
  8234. @item @b{DREXIT1}
  8235. @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
  8236. for update or more shifting
  8237. @item @b{DREXIT2}
  8238. @item @b{DRUPDATE}
  8239. @item @b{IRSELECT}
  8240. @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
  8241. @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
  8242. through the instruction register
  8243. @item @b{IREXIT1}
  8244. @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
  8245. for update or more shifting
  8246. @item @b{IREXIT2}
  8247. @item @b{IRUPDATE}
  8248. @end itemize
  8249. Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
  8250. face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
  8251. and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
  8252. others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
  8253. @itemize @bullet
  8254. @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
  8255. produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
  8256. to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
  8257. may not be as expected.
  8258. @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
  8259. choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
  8260. since they are free of JTAG side effects.
  8261. @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
  8262. levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
  8263. Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
  8264. @end itemize
  8265. @node Boundary Scan Commands
  8266. @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
  8267. One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
  8268. boundary scan based hardware testing.
  8269. Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
  8270. OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
  8271. @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
  8272. @cindex Serial Vector Format
  8273. @cindex SVF
  8274. The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
  8275. way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
  8276. In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8277. OpenOCD supports running such test files.
  8278. @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
  8279. [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
  8280. This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
  8281. runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
  8282. Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
  8283. affect their semantics.
  8284. Command options:
  8285. @itemize @minus
  8286. @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
  8287. specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
  8288. instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
  8289. chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
  8290. @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
  8291. @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
  8292. on the real interface;
  8293. @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
  8294. @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
  8295. errors.
  8296. @end itemize
  8297. @end deffn
  8298. @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
  8299. @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
  8300. @cindex XSVF
  8301. The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
  8302. binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
  8303. Xilinx devices.
  8304. In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8305. OpenOCD supports running such test files.
  8306. @quotation Important
  8307. Not all XSVF commands are supported.
  8308. @end quotation
  8309. @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
  8310. This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
  8311. runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
  8312. When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
  8313. that TAP.
  8314. When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
  8315. are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
  8316. Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
  8317. messages are logged for comments and some retries.
  8318. @end deffn
  8319. The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
  8320. for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
  8321. after building the software.
  8322. You may find them useful:
  8323. @itemize
  8324. @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
  8325. syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
  8326. @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
  8327. understands the OpenOCD extensions.
  8328. @end itemize
  8329. The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
  8330. These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
  8331. from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
  8332. two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
  8333. (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
  8334. If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
  8335. probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
  8336. @node Utility Commands
  8337. @chapter Utility Commands
  8338. @cindex Utility Commands
  8339. @section RAM testing
  8340. @cindex RAM testing
  8341. There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
  8342. errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
  8343. testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
  8344. electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
  8345. hardware problems.
  8346. To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
  8347. consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
  8348. register operations and translate them to the corresponding
  8349. @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
  8350. Load the memory testing functions with
  8351. @example
  8352. source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
  8353. @end example
  8354. to get access to the following facilities:
  8355. @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
  8356. Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
  8357. 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
  8358. @end deffn
  8359. @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
  8360. Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
  8361. check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
  8362. such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
  8363. @end deffn
  8364. @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
  8365. Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
  8366. increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
  8367. storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
  8368. @end deffn
  8369. @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
  8370. Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
  8371. @end deffn
  8372. @section Firmware recovery helpers
  8373. @cindex Firmware recovery
  8374. OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
  8375. devices recovery with JTAG.
  8376. For quickstart instructions run:
  8377. @example
  8378. openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
  8379. @end example
  8380. @node TFTP
  8381. @chapter TFTP
  8382. @cindex TFTP
  8383. If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
  8384. be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
  8385. The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
  8386. "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
  8387. server (tftpd). For example,
  8388. @example
  8389. load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
  8390. @end example
  8391. will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
  8392. if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
  8393. In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
  8394. that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
  8395. are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
  8396. a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
  8397. @node GDB and OpenOCD
  8398. @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
  8399. @cindex GDB
  8400. OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
  8401. to debug remote targets.
  8402. Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
  8403. @itemize
  8404. @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
  8405. @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
  8406. @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
  8407. as shown in this chapter.
  8408. @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
  8409. that also will probably need to be configured.
  8410. @end itemize
  8411. Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
  8412. been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
  8413. part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
  8414. cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
  8415. x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
  8416. if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
  8417. @section Connecting to GDB
  8418. @cindex Connecting to GDB
  8419. Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
  8420. instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
  8421. errors, which has since been fixed; see
  8422. @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
  8423. OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
  8424. @enumerate
  8425. @item
  8426. A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
  8427. @example
  8428. target remote localhost:3333
  8429. @end example
  8430. This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
  8431. It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
  8432. @example
  8433. target extended-remote localhost:3333
  8434. @end example
  8435. @item
  8436. A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
  8437. @example
  8438. target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
  8439. @end example
  8440. This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
  8441. Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
  8442. session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
  8443. not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
  8444. @end enumerate
  8445. To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
  8446. GDB command line.
  8447. @section Sample GDB session startup
  8448. With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
  8449. than they do when you're debugging locally.
  8450. Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
  8451. small ARM program.
  8452. In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
  8453. Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
  8454. @example
  8455. $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
  8456. (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
  8457. Remote debugging using localhost:3333
  8458. ...
  8459. (gdb) monitor reset halt
  8460. ...
  8461. (gdb) load
  8462. Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
  8463. Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
  8464. Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
  8465. Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
  8466. Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
  8467. (gdb) continue
  8468. Continuing.
  8469. ...
  8470. @end example
  8471. You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
  8472. type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
  8473. code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
  8474. set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
  8475. @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
  8476. OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
  8477. to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
  8478. packet size and the device's memory map.
  8479. You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
  8480. and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
  8481. set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
  8482. However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
  8483. You may need to set those up by hand.
  8484. As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
  8485. something like:
  8486. @example
  8487. Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
  8488. @end example
  8489. You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
  8490. @example
  8491. set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
  8492. set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
  8493. @end example
  8494. With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
  8495. only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
  8496. do not have such restrictions.
  8497. Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
  8498. save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
  8499. using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
  8500. using @command{gdb -x filename}.
  8501. @section Programming using GDB
  8502. @cindex Programming using GDB
  8503. @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
  8504. By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
  8505. the following OpenOCD configuration option:
  8506. @example
  8507. gdb_memory_map disable
  8508. @end example
  8509. For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
  8510. in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
  8511. working area.
  8512. Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
  8513. flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
  8514. that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
  8515. using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
  8516. To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
  8517. All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
  8518. GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
  8519. This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
  8520. @example
  8521. set mem inaccessible-by-default off
  8522. @end example
  8523. If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
  8524. program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
  8525. GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
  8526. areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
  8527. will be used.
  8528. If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
  8529. event gdb-flash-erase-start:
  8530. @example
  8531. $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
  8532. @end example
  8533. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
  8534. To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
  8535. can be used.
  8536. @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
  8537. @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
  8538. @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
  8539. If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
  8540. robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
  8541. just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
  8542. OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
  8543. Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
  8544. and GDB treats it as it were running.
  8545. If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
  8546. you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
  8547. without any intrusion of the target process.
  8548. Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  8549. Place following command after target configuration:
  8550. @example
  8551. $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
  8552. @end example
  8553. If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
  8554. switch off gdb_memory_map:
  8555. @example
  8556. gdb_memory_map disable
  8557. @end example
  8558. Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
  8559. Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
  8560. @example
  8561. set remote interrupt-on-connect off
  8562. @end example
  8563. If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
  8564. manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
  8565. Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
  8566. of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
  8567. @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
  8568. and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
  8569. Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
  8570. previously shown varibles.
  8571. @section RTOS Support
  8572. @cindex RTOS Support
  8573. @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
  8574. OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
  8575. It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
  8576. @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
  8577. Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
  8578. GDB commands.
  8579. @* An example setup is below:
  8580. @example
  8581. $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
  8582. @end example
  8583. This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
  8584. Currently supported rtos's include:
  8585. @itemize @bullet
  8586. @item @option{eCos}
  8587. @item @option{ThreadX}
  8588. @item @option{FreeRTOS}
  8589. @item @option{linux}
  8590. @item @option{ChibiOS}
  8591. @item @option{embKernel}
  8592. @item @option{mqx}
  8593. @item @option{uCOS-III}
  8594. @item @option{nuttx}
  8595. @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
  8596. @end itemize
  8597. Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
  8598. be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
  8599. @table @code
  8600. @item eCos symbols
  8601. Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
  8602. @item ThreadX symbols
  8603. _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
  8604. @item FreeRTOS symbols
  8605. @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
  8606. @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
  8607. @tex
  8608. \begingroup
  8609. \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
  8610. pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
  8611. pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
  8612. uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
  8613. \par
  8614. \endgroup
  8615. @end tex
  8616. @item linux symbols
  8617. init_task.
  8618. @item ChibiOS symbols
  8619. rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
  8620. @item embKernel symbols
  8621. Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
  8622. Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
  8623. @item mqx symbols
  8624. _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
  8625. @item uC/OS-III symbols
  8626. OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
  8627. @item nuttx symbols
  8628. g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
  8629. @end table
  8630. For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
  8631. some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
  8632. These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
  8633. along with the project:
  8634. @table @code
  8635. @item FreeRTOS
  8636. contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
  8637. @item uC/OS-III
  8638. contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
  8639. @end table
  8640. @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
  8641. @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
  8642. @cindex SMP
  8643. @cindex RTOS
  8644. @cindex hwthread
  8645. OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
  8646. ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
  8647. GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
  8648. After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
  8649. list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
  8650. command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
  8651. The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
  8652. while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
  8653. scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
  8654. @section Legacy SMP core switching support
  8655. @quotation Note
  8656. This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
  8657. @end quotation
  8658. For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
  8659. @itemize @bullet
  8660. @item j - smp status request
  8661. @item J - smp set request
  8662. @end itemize
  8663. OpenOCD implements :
  8664. @itemize @bullet
  8665. @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
  8666. GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
  8667. @option{E01} for target not smp.
  8668. @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
  8669. (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
  8670. for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
  8671. @end itemize
  8672. Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
  8673. @itemize @bullet
  8674. @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
  8675. of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
  8676. @example
  8677. set $_core 1
  8678. #Jc01 packet is sent
  8679. print $_core
  8680. #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
  8681. @end example
  8682. @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
  8683. core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
  8684. @example
  8685. # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
  8686. define toggle0
  8687. maint packet Jc0
  8688. continue
  8689. main packet Jc-1
  8690. end
  8691. # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
  8692. define toggle1
  8693. maint packet Jc1
  8694. continue
  8695. main packet Jc-1
  8696. end
  8697. @end example
  8698. @end itemize
  8699. @node Tcl Scripting API
  8700. @chapter Tcl Scripting API
  8701. @cindex Tcl Scripting API
  8702. @cindex Tcl scripts
  8703. @section API rules
  8704. Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
  8705. a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
  8706. of state information as an argument to each proc.
  8707. There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
  8708. pair list and lists.
  8709. Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
  8710. list.
  8711. @example
  8712. > set foo(me) Duane
  8713. > set foo(you) Oyvind
  8714. > set foo(mouse) Micky
  8715. > set foo(duck) Donald
  8716. @end example
  8717. If one does this:
  8718. @example
  8719. > set foo
  8720. @end example
  8721. The result is:
  8722. @example
  8723. me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
  8724. @end example
  8725. Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
  8726. @verbatim
  8727. foreach { name value } [set foo] {
  8728. puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
  8729. }
  8730. @end verbatim
  8731. Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
  8732. should be passed in to the proc in question.
  8733. @section Internal low-level Commands
  8734. By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
  8735. invoke directly.
  8736. @itemize @bullet
  8737. @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
  8738. Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
  8739. @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
  8740. Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
  8741. @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
  8742. Return information about the flash banks
  8743. @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
  8744. Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
  8745. its execution. Example:
  8746. @example
  8747. > capture "reset init"
  8748. @end example
  8749. @end itemize
  8750. OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
  8751. @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
  8752. called "flash_banks".
  8753. @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
  8754. Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
  8755. variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
  8756. holds one of the following values:
  8757. @itemize @bullet
  8758. @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
  8759. @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
  8760. @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
  8761. @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
  8762. @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
  8763. @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
  8764. @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
  8765. @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
  8766. @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
  8767. @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
  8768. @end itemize
  8769. Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
  8770. @quotation Note
  8771. We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
  8772. @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
  8773. @code{jim_platform} (because it
  8774. is jim, not real tcl).
  8775. @end quotation
  8776. @section Tcl RPC server
  8777. @cindex RPC
  8778. OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
  8779. commands and receive the results.
  8780. To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
  8781. (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
  8782. interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
  8783. value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
  8784. repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
  8785. It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
  8786. @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
  8787. @command{capture} command.
  8788. See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
  8789. @section Tcl RPC server notifications
  8790. @cindex RPC Notifications
  8791. Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
  8792. the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
  8793. Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
  8794. in the following format.
  8795. @verbatim
  8796. type target_event event [event-name]
  8797. type target_state state [state-name]
  8798. type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
  8799. @end verbatim
  8800. @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
  8801. Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
  8802. Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
  8803. Defaults to off.
  8804. @end deffn
  8805. @section Tcl RPC server trace output
  8806. @cindex RPC trace output
  8807. Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
  8808. the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
  8809. Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
  8810. @verbatim
  8811. type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
  8812. @end verbatim
  8813. @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
  8814. Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
  8815. Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
  8816. Defaults to off.
  8817. See an example application here:
  8818. @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
  8819. @end deffn
  8820. @node FAQ
  8821. @chapter FAQ
  8822. @cindex faq
  8823. @enumerate
  8824. @anchor{faqrtck}
  8825. @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
  8826. @cindex RTCK
  8827. @cindex adaptive clocking
  8828. @*
  8829. In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
  8830. synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
  8831. operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
  8832. The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
  8833. In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
  8834. well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
  8835. for example. There are 2 basic options:
  8836. @enumerate
  8837. @item
  8838. Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
  8839. clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
  8840. @item
  8841. The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
  8842. the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
  8843. @end enumerate
  8844. @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
  8845. is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
  8846. the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
  8847. Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
  8848. situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
  8849. power).
  8850. For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
  8851. a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
  8852. and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
  8853. ARM926 scenario).
  8854. If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
  8855. the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
  8856. JTAG can use a faster clock.
  8857. Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
  8858. device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
  8859. clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
  8860. that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
  8861. @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
  8862. In order to make use of this,
  8863. your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
  8864. feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
  8865. The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
  8866. this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
  8867. this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
  8868. 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
  8869. work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
  8870. The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
  8871. held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
  8872. time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
  8873. down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
  8874. Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
  8875. when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
  8876. Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
  8877. both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
  8878. with a CPLD.
  8879. It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
  8880. to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
  8881. back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
  8882. Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
  8883. for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
  8884. @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
  8885. @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
  8886. Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
  8887. In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
  8888. the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
  8889. depending on the chips on your board.
  8890. @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
  8891. ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
  8892. @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
  8893. Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
  8894. maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
  8895. often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
  8896. You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
  8897. either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
  8898. manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
  8899. and tedious, and is not always practical.)
  8900. It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
  8901. have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
  8902. sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
  8903. this way.
  8904. Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
  8905. operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
  8906. clock rate.
  8907. That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
  8908. prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
  8909. cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
  8910. To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
  8911. @example
  8912. # Example: 1.234MHz
  8913. adapter_khz 1234
  8914. @end example
  8915. @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
  8916. OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
  8917. around Windows filenames.
  8918. @example
  8919. > echo \a
  8920. > echo @{\a@}
  8921. \a
  8922. > echo "\a"
  8923. >
  8924. @end example
  8925. @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
  8926. Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
  8927. claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
  8928. OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
  8929. @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
  8930. Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
  8931. arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
  8932. GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
  8933. source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
  8934. software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
  8935. @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
  8936. Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
  8937. clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
  8938. frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
  8939. (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
  8940. @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
  8941. I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
  8942. out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
  8943. Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
  8944. settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
  8945. @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
  8946. I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
  8947. memory read caused data abort".
  8948. The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
  8949. beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
  8950. a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
  8951. be done, feel free to add this here.
  8952. @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
  8953. stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
  8954. time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
  8955. call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
  8956. happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
  8957. stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
  8958. gracefully stops.
  8959. @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
  8960. your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
  8961. remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
  8962. @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
  8963. often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
  8964. bytes. Painful...
  8965. @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
  8966. "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
  8967. This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
  8968. debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
  8969. trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
  8970. your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
  8971. independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
  8972. reset, everything else should work fine.
  8973. @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
  8974. toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
  8975. unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
  8976. quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
  8977. No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
  8978. this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
  8979. Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
  8980. supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
  8981. @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
  8982. @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
  8983. error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
  8984. What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
  8985. Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
  8986. has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
  8987. @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
  8988. are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
  8989. for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
  8990. 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
  8991. specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
  8992. frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
  8993. i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
  8994. clock frequency?
  8995. No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
  8996. However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
  8997. routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
  8998. the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
  8999. frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
  9000. @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
  9001. Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
  9002. devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
  9003. order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
  9004. listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
  9005. which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
  9006. right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
  9007. references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
  9008. You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
  9009. Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
  9010. processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
  9011. else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
  9012. up DRAM and loading it with code.
  9013. @anchor{faqtaporder}
  9014. @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
  9015. particular order?
  9016. Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
  9017. the same order used by the hardware.
  9018. Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
  9019. STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
  9020. ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
  9021. RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
  9022. connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
  9023. Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
  9024. Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
  9025. (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
  9026. chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
  9027. place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
  9028. @itemize @bullet
  9029. @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
  9030. @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
  9031. @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
  9032. @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
  9033. @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
  9034. @end itemize
  9035. The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
  9036. @itemize @bullet
  9037. @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
  9038. @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
  9039. @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
  9040. @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
  9041. @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
  9042. @end itemize
  9043. @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
  9044. log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
  9045. arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
  9046. TODO.
  9047. @end enumerate
  9048. @node Tcl Crash Course
  9049. @chapter Tcl Crash Course
  9050. @cindex Tcl
  9051. Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
  9052. learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
  9053. how the Tcl scripts work.
  9054. This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
  9055. who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
  9056. something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
  9057. OpenOCD.
  9058. @section Tcl Rule #1
  9059. There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
  9060. @enumerate
  9061. @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
  9062. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9063. @end enumerate
  9064. The Tcl equal is this:
  9065. @enumerate
  9066. @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
  9067. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9068. @end enumerate
  9069. As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
  9070. you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
  9071. @section Tcl Rule #1b
  9072. There is a second pair of rules.
  9073. @enumerate
  9074. @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
  9075. @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
  9076. flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
  9077. in Tcl.
  9078. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9079. @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
  9080. convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
  9081. those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
  9082. @end enumerate
  9083. @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
  9084. Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
  9085. deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
  9086. Everything is a string}
  9087. @section Tcl Quoting Operators
  9088. In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
  9089. difference is subtle.
  9090. @enumerate
  9091. @item Parse Time
  9092. @item Evaluation Time
  9093. @end enumerate
  9094. The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
  9095. three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
  9096. @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
  9097. By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
  9098. sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
  9099. in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
  9100. = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
  9101. @itemize @bullet
  9102. @item @b{[square-brackets]}
  9103. @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
  9104. like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
  9105. operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
  9106. string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
  9107. @example
  9108. # bash example
  9109. X=`date`
  9110. echo "The Date is: $X"
  9111. # Tcl example
  9112. set X [date]
  9113. puts "The Date is: $X"
  9114. @end example
  9115. @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
  9116. @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
  9117. text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
  9118. result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
  9119. is a string}
  9120. @example
  9121. set x "Dinner"
  9122. puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
  9123. @end example
  9124. @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
  9125. @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
  9126. parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
  9127. 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
  9128. feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
  9129. nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
  9130. at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
  9131. @end itemize
  9132. @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
  9133. The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
  9134. @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
  9135. Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
  9136. the normal way.
  9137. As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
  9138. tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
  9139. line is immediately executed.
  9140. Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
  9141. @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
  9142. @subsection Command Execution
  9143. Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
  9144. statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
  9145. control flow operators.
  9146. Commands are executed like this:
  9147. @enumerate
  9148. @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
  9149. @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
  9150. @item Repeat until End Of File.
  9151. @end enumerate
  9152. It sort of works like this:
  9153. @example
  9154. for(;;)@{
  9155. ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
  9156. cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
  9157. (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
  9158. @}
  9159. @end example
  9160. When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
  9161. function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
  9162. the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
  9163. of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
  9164. command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
  9165. ``LookupCommand()''
  9166. @subsection The FOR command
  9167. The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
  9168. the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
  9169. command just like any other command.
  9170. When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
  9171. produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
  9172. are:
  9173. @enumerate 0
  9174. @item The ascii text 'for'
  9175. @item The start text
  9176. @item The test expression
  9177. @item The next text
  9178. @item The body text
  9179. @end enumerate
  9180. Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
  9181. Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
  9182. Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
  9183. variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
  9184. Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
  9185. argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
  9186. @example
  9187. int
  9188. MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
  9189. int *argc,
  9190. Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
  9191. @end example
  9192. Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
  9193. introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
  9194. still operates in the same basic way.
  9195. @subsection FOR command implementation
  9196. To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
  9197. command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
  9198. In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
  9199. Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
  9200. The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
  9201. string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
  9202. parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
  9203. The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
  9204. expression and returns a value.
  9205. Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
  9206. implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
  9207. @example
  9208. void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
  9209. int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
  9210. int
  9211. MyForCommand( void *interp,
  9212. int argc,
  9213. char **argv )
  9214. @{
  9215. if( argc != 5 )@{
  9216. SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
  9217. return ERROR;
  9218. @}
  9219. // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
  9220. // Execute the start statement.
  9221. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
  9222. // Top of loop test
  9223. for(;;)@{
  9224. i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
  9225. if( i == 0 )
  9226. break;
  9227. // Execute the body
  9228. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
  9229. // Execute the LOOP part
  9230. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
  9231. @}
  9232. // Return no error
  9233. SetResult( interp, "" );
  9234. return SUCCESS;
  9235. @}
  9236. @end example
  9237. Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
  9238. in the same basic way.
  9239. @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
  9240. @subsection source and find commands
  9241. @b{Where:} In many configuration files
  9242. @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
  9243. @*Remember the parsing rules
  9244. @enumerate
  9245. @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
  9246. and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
  9247. the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
  9248. The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
  9249. place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
  9250. (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
  9251. That character begins Tcl comments.)
  9252. @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
  9253. it reads a file and executes as a script.
  9254. @end enumerate
  9255. @subsection format command
  9256. @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
  9257. @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
  9258. @b{sprintf()}.
  9259. @b{Example}
  9260. @example
  9261. set x 6
  9262. set y 7
  9263. puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
  9264. @end example
  9265. @enumerate
  9266. @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
  9267. @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
  9268. @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
  9269. @* Refer to Rule #1
  9270. @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
  9271. @* Refer to Rule #1.
  9272. @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
  9273. @end enumerate
  9274. @subsection Body or Inlined Text
  9275. @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
  9276. @example
  9277. #1 Good
  9278. proc someproc @{@} @{
  9279. ... multiple lines of stuff ...
  9280. @}
  9281. $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
  9282. #2 Good - no variables
  9283. $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
  9284. #3 Good Curly Braces
  9285. $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
  9286. puts "Time: [date]"
  9287. @}
  9288. #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
  9289. $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
  9290. @end example
  9291. @enumerate
  9292. @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
  9293. @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
  9294. each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
  9295. the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
  9296. the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
  9297. command.
  9298. @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
  9299. @*There are 4 examples:
  9300. @enumerate
  9301. @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
  9302. @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
  9303. @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
  9304. @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
  9305. @end enumerate
  9306. In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
  9307. evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
  9308. Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
  9309. Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
  9310. $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
  9311. and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
  9312. ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
  9313. $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
  9314. change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
  9315. Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
  9316. @end enumerate
  9317. @subsection Global Variables
  9318. @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
  9319. simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
  9320. you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
  9321. @example
  9322. proc myproc @{ @} @{
  9323. set y 0 #Local variable Y
  9324. global x #Global variable X
  9325. puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
  9326. @}
  9327. @end example
  9328. @section Other Tcl Hacks
  9329. @b{Dynamic variable creation}
  9330. @example
  9331. # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
  9332. for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
  9333. # Create var name
  9334. set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
  9335. # Make it a global
  9336. global $vn
  9337. # Set it.
  9338. set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
  9339. @}
  9340. @end example
  9341. @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
  9342. @example
  9343. # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
  9344. foreach who @{A B C D E@}
  9345. proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
  9346. @}
  9347. @end example
  9348. @include fdl.texi
  9349. @node OpenOCD Concept Index
  9350. @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
  9351. @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
  9352. @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
  9353. @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
  9354. @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
  9355. @printindex cp
  9356. @node Command and Driver Index
  9357. @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
  9358. @printindex fn
  9359. @bye